Rename `image-library-alist' to `dynamic-library-alist'.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blobd9d908d439661bfd8f0d2f4d1dbbdb6b6e6d4608
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
8 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
13 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
22 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24 #include <config.h>
25 #include <signal.h>
26 #include <stdio.h>
27 #include <setjmp.h>
29 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
31 #include "lisp.h"
32 #include "blockinput.h"
34 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
35 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
36 #include "syssignal.h"
38 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
39 if this is not done before the other system files. */
40 #include "xterm.h"
41 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
43 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
44 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
45 #ifndef makedev
46 #include <sys/types.h>
47 #endif /* makedev */
49 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H
50 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
51 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H) */
53 #include "systime.h"
55 #include <fcntl.h>
56 #include <ctype.h>
57 #include <errno.h>
58 #include <setjmp.h>
59 #include <sys/stat.h>
60 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
61 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
63 #include "charset.h"
64 #include "character.h"
65 #include "coding.h"
66 #include "frame.h"
67 #include "dispextern.h"
68 #include "fontset.h"
69 #include "termhooks.h"
70 #include "termopts.h"
71 #include "termchar.h"
72 #include "emacs-icon.h"
73 #include "disptab.h"
74 #include "buffer.h"
75 #include "window.h"
76 #include "keyboard.h"
77 #include "intervals.h"
78 #include "process.h"
79 #include "atimer.h"
80 #include "keymap.h"
81 #include "font.h"
82 #include "fontset.h"
83 #include "xsettings.h"
84 #include "xgselect.h"
85 #include "sysselect.h"
87 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
88 #include <X11/Shell.h>
89 #endif
91 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
92 #include <sys/time.h>
93 #endif
94 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
95 #include <unistd.h>
96 #endif
98 #ifdef USE_GTK
99 #include "gtkutil.h"
100 #endif
102 #ifdef USE_LUCID
103 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
104 #endif
106 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
107 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
108 #define HACK_EDITRES
109 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
110 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
112 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
114 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
115 #if defined USE_MOTIF
116 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
117 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
118 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
120 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
121 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
123 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
124 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
125 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
126 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
127 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
128 #ifndef XtNpickTop
129 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
130 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
131 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
132 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
134 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
136 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
137 #include "widget.h"
138 #ifndef XtNinitialState
139 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
140 #endif
141 #endif
143 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
144 #ifdef USE_XIM
145 int use_xim = 1;
146 #else
147 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
148 #endif
152 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
154 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
156 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
157 start. */
159 static int any_help_event_p;
161 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
162 static Lisp_Object last_window;
164 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
166 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
168 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
170 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
172 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
173 use. */
175 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
177 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
178 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
179 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
180 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
182 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
184 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
185 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
186 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
187 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
189 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
191 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
193 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
195 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
197 static struct {
198 struct frame *f;
199 int eventtype;
200 } pending_event_wait;
202 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
203 /* The application context for Xt use. */
204 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
205 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
206 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
208 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
210 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
212 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
213 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
215 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
217 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
218 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
219 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
221 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
223 /* Mouse movement.
225 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
226 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
227 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
228 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
230 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
232 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
233 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
234 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
235 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
236 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
237 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
238 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
239 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
240 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
241 is off. */
243 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
245 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
246 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
247 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
249 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
251 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
252 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
253 an ordinary motion.
255 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
256 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
257 event. */
259 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
261 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
262 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
263 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
264 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
265 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
266 it's somewhat accurate. */
268 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
270 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
272 static Time last_user_time;
274 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
275 events. */
277 #ifdef __STDC__
278 static int volatile input_signal_count;
279 #else
280 static int input_signal_count;
281 #endif
283 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
285 static int x_noop_count;
287 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
289 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
290 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
291 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
293 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
294 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
296 #ifdef USE_GTK
297 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
298 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
300 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
301 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
302 #endif
304 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
305 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
307 /* Used in x_flush. */
309 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources (Display *, const char *, const char *,
310 const char *);
311 extern int x_bitmap_mask (FRAME_PTR, int);
313 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
314 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
315 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
316 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
318 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
319 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
320 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
321 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
322 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
323 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
324 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
325 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
326 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
327 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
328 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
329 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
330 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
331 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
332 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
333 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
334 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
335 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
336 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
337 enum text_cursor_kinds);
339 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
340 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
341 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
342 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
343 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
344 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
345 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
346 enum scroll_bar_part *,
347 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
348 unsigned long *);
349 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
350 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
351 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
352 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
353 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
354 int *, struct input_event *);
355 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
356 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
357 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
360 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
362 static void
363 x_flush (struct frame *f)
365 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
366 connection may be broken. */
367 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
368 return;
370 BLOCK_INPUT;
371 if (f == NULL)
373 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
374 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
375 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
376 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
378 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
379 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
380 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
384 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
385 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
386 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
387 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
388 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
389 performance. */
391 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
394 /***********************************************************************
395 Debugging
396 ***********************************************************************/
398 #if 0
400 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
401 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
403 struct record
405 char *locus;
406 int type;
409 struct record event_record[100];
411 int event_record_index;
413 record_event (locus, type)
414 char *locus;
415 int type;
417 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
418 event_record_index = 0;
420 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
421 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
422 event_record_index++;
425 #endif /* 0 */
429 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
431 struct x_display_info *
432 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
434 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
436 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
437 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
438 return dpyinfo;
440 return 0;
443 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
444 #define OPACITY "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY"
446 void
447 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
449 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
450 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
451 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
452 double alpha = 1.0;
453 double alpha_min = 1.0;
454 unsigned long opac;
456 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window != FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc)
457 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
458 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
459 win = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
461 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
462 alpha = f->alpha[0];
463 else
464 alpha = f->alpha[1];
466 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
467 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
468 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
469 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
471 if (alpha < 0.0)
472 return;
473 else if (alpha > 1.0)
474 alpha = 1.0;
475 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
476 alpha = alpha_min;
478 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
480 /* return unless necessary */
482 unsigned char *data;
483 Atom actual;
484 int rc, format;
485 unsigned long n, left;
487 x_catch_errors (dpy);
488 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, XInternAtom(dpy, OPACITY, False),
489 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
490 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
491 &data);
493 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
494 if (*(unsigned long *)data == opac)
496 XFree ((void *) data);
497 x_uncatch_errors ();
498 return;
500 else
501 XFree ((void *) data);
502 x_uncatch_errors ();
505 x_catch_errors (dpy);
506 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, XInternAtom (dpy, OPACITY, False),
507 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
508 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
509 x_uncatch_errors ();
513 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
515 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
519 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
521 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
525 /***********************************************************************
526 Starting and ending an update
527 ***********************************************************************/
529 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
530 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
531 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
532 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
533 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
535 static void
536 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
538 /* Nothing to do. */
542 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
543 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
544 position of W. */
546 static void
547 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
549 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
550 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
552 updated_window = w;
553 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
555 BLOCK_INPUT;
557 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
559 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
560 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
562 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
563 highlighting. */
564 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
565 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
568 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
572 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
574 static void
575 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
577 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
578 struct face *face;
580 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
581 if (face)
582 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
583 face->foreground);
585 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
586 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
589 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
591 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
592 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
594 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
595 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
596 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
598 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
599 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
600 here. */
602 static void
603 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
605 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
607 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
609 BLOCK_INPUT;
611 if (cursor_on_p)
612 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
613 output_cursor.vpos,
614 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
616 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
617 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
619 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
622 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
623 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
624 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
626 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
627 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
628 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
631 updated_window = NULL;
635 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
636 update_end. */
638 static void
639 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
641 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
642 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
644 #ifndef XFlush
645 BLOCK_INPUT;
646 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
647 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
648 #endif
652 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
653 complete update has been performed. The global variable
654 updated_window is not available here. */
656 static void
657 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
659 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
661 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
663 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
664 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
666 BLOCK_INPUT;
667 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
668 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
669 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
670 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
671 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
672 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
678 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
679 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
680 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
681 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
682 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
683 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
685 static void
686 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
688 struct window *w = updated_window;
689 struct frame *f;
690 int width, height;
692 xassert (w);
694 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
695 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
697 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
698 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
699 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
700 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
701 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
702 overhead is very small. */
703 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
704 && desired_row->full_width_p
705 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
706 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
707 width != 0)
708 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
709 height > 0))
711 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
713 BLOCK_INPUT;
714 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
715 0, y, width, height, False);
716 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
717 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
718 y, width, height, False);
719 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
723 static void
724 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
726 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
727 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
728 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
729 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
730 struct face *face = p->face;
732 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
733 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
735 if (!p->overlay_p)
737 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
739 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
740 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
741 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
742 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
743 if (face->stipple)
744 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
745 else
746 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
748 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
749 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
750 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
751 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
752 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
753 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
754 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
755 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
757 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
759 if (sb_width > 0)
761 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
762 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
763 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
765 if (bx < 0)
767 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
768 if (left + width == p->x)
769 bx = left + sb_width;
770 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
771 bx = left;
772 if (bx >= 0)
774 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
776 nx = width - sb_width;
777 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
778 row->y));
779 ny = row->visible_height;
782 else
784 if (left + width == bx)
786 bx = left + sb_width;
787 nx += width - sb_width;
789 else if (bx + nx == left)
790 nx += width - sb_width;
794 #endif
795 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
796 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
798 if (!face->stipple)
799 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
802 if (p->which)
804 unsigned char *bits;
805 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
806 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
807 XGCValues gcv;
809 if (p->wd > 8)
810 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
811 else
812 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
814 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
815 by the server. */
816 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
817 (p->cursor_p
818 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
819 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
820 : face->foreground),
821 face->background, depth);
823 if (p->overlay_p)
825 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
826 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
827 bits, p->wd, p->h,
828 1, 0, 1);
829 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
830 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
831 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
832 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
835 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
836 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
837 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
839 if (p->overlay_p)
841 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
842 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
843 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
847 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
852 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
853 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
854 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
855 rarely happens). */
857 static void
858 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
862 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
863 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
865 static void
866 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
871 /***********************************************************************
872 Glyph display
873 ***********************************************************************/
877 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
878 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
880 int);
881 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
883 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
884 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
886 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
888 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
889 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
890 unsigned long *, double, int);
891 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
892 double, int, unsigned long);
893 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
897 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
898 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
899 int, int, int);
900 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
901 int, int, int, int, int, int,
902 XRectangle *);
903 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
904 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
906 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
907 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
908 #endif
911 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
912 face. */
914 static void
915 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
917 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
918 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
919 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
920 && !s->cmp)
921 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
922 else
924 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
925 XGCValues xgcv;
926 unsigned long mask;
928 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
929 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
931 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
932 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
933 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
934 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
935 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
936 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
937 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
939 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
940 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
941 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
943 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
944 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
947 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
949 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
951 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
952 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
953 mask, &xgcv);
954 else
955 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
956 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
958 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
963 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
965 static void
966 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
968 int face_id;
969 struct face *face;
971 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
972 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
973 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
974 if (face == NULL)
975 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
977 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
978 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
979 else
980 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
981 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
982 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
984 if (s->font == s->face->font)
985 s->gc = s->face->gc;
986 else
988 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
989 except for FONT. */
990 XGCValues xgcv;
991 unsigned long mask;
993 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
994 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
995 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
996 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
998 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
999 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1000 mask, &xgcv);
1001 else
1002 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1003 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1005 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1008 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1012 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1013 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1014 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1016 static INLINE void
1017 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1019 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1023 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1024 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1025 pattern. */
1027 static INLINE void
1028 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1030 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1032 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1034 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1035 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1037 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1039 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1040 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1042 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1044 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1045 s->stippled_p = 0;
1047 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1049 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1050 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1052 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1053 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1055 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1056 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1058 else
1060 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1064 /* GC must have been set. */
1065 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1069 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1070 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1072 static INLINE void
1073 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1075 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1076 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1078 if (n > 0)
1079 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1080 s->num_clips = n;
1084 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1085 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1086 the area of SRC. */
1088 static void
1089 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1091 XRectangle r;
1093 r.x = src->x;
1094 r.width = src->width;
1095 r.y = src->y;
1096 r.height = src->height;
1097 dst->clip[0] = r;
1098 dst->num_clips = 1;
1099 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1103 /* RIF:
1104 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1106 static void
1107 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1109 if (s->cmp == NULL
1110 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1111 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1113 struct font_metrics metrics;
1115 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1117 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1118 struct font *font = s->font;
1119 int i;
1121 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1122 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1123 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1125 else
1127 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1129 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1131 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1132 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1133 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1135 else if (s->cmp)
1137 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1138 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1143 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1145 static INLINE void
1146 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1148 XGCValues xgcv;
1149 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1150 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1151 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1152 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1156 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1157 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1158 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1159 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1160 contains the first component of a composition. */
1162 static void
1163 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1165 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1166 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1167 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1169 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1171 if (s->stippled_p)
1173 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1174 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1175 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1176 s->y + box_line_width,
1177 s->background_width,
1178 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1179 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1180 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1182 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1183 || s->font_not_found_p
1184 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1185 || force_p)
1187 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1188 s->background_width,
1189 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1190 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1196 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1198 static void
1199 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1201 int i, x;
1203 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1204 of S to the right of that box line. */
1205 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1206 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1207 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1208 else
1209 x = s->x;
1211 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1212 loaded. */
1213 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1215 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1217 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1218 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1219 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1220 s->height - 1);
1221 x += g->pixel_width;
1224 else
1226 struct font *font = s->font;
1227 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1228 int y;
1230 if (font->vertical_centering)
1231 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1233 y = s->ybase - boff;
1234 if (s->for_overlaps
1235 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1236 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1237 else
1238 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1239 if (s->face->overstrike)
1240 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1244 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1246 static void
1247 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1249 int i, j, x;
1250 struct font *font = s->font;
1252 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1253 of S to the right of that box line. */
1254 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1255 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1256 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1257 else
1258 x = s->x;
1260 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1261 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1262 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1263 this composition. */
1265 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1266 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1267 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1269 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1270 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1271 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1273 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1275 int y = s->ybase;
1277 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1278 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1280 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1281 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1283 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1284 if (s->face->overstrike)
1285 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1288 else
1290 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1291 Lisp_Object glyph;
1292 int y = s->ybase;
1293 int width = 0;
1295 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1297 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1298 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1299 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1300 else
1302 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1304 if (j < i)
1306 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1307 if (s->face->overstrike)
1308 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1309 x += width;
1311 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1312 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1313 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1314 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1315 if (s->face->overstrike)
1316 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1317 x += wadjust;
1318 j = i + 1;
1319 width = 0;
1322 if (j < i)
1324 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1325 if (s->face->overstrike)
1326 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1332 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1334 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1335 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1336 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1337 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1338 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1341 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1342 cannot be determined. */
1344 static struct frame *
1345 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1347 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1348 Lisp_Object tail;
1349 struct frame *f;
1351 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1353 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1354 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1355 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1356 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1357 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1358 widget = XtParent (widget);
1360 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1361 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1362 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1363 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1364 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1365 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1366 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1367 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1368 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1369 return f;
1371 abort ();
1375 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1376 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1377 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1378 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1381 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1383 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1384 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1388 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1389 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1390 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1391 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1392 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1393 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1396 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1397 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1399 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1400 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1404 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1405 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1407 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1409 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1410 sizeof (Screen *)},
1411 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1412 sizeof (Colormap)}
1416 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1417 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1419 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1422 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1424 DPY is the display we are working on.
1426 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1427 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1428 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1429 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1431 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1432 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1434 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1435 we allocated the color or not.
1437 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1439 static Boolean
1440 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1441 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1442 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1444 Screen *screen;
1445 Colormap cmap;
1446 Pixel pixel;
1447 String color_name;
1448 XColor color;
1450 if (*nargs != 2)
1452 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1453 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1454 "XtToolkitError",
1455 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1456 return False;
1459 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1460 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1461 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1463 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1465 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1466 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1468 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1470 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1471 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1473 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1474 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1476 pixel = color.pixel;
1477 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1479 else
1481 String params[1];
1482 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1484 params[0] = color_name;
1485 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1486 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1487 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1488 params, &nparams);
1489 return False;
1492 if (to->addr != NULL)
1494 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1496 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1497 return False;
1500 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1502 else
1504 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1505 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1508 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1509 return True;
1513 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1514 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1515 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1517 APP is the application context in which we work.
1519 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1520 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1521 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1523 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1525 static void
1526 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1527 Cardinal *nargs)
1529 if (*nargs != 2)
1531 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1532 "XtToolkitError",
1533 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1534 NULL, NULL);
1536 else if (closure != NULL)
1538 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1539 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1540 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1541 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1542 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1547 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1550 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1551 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1552 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1553 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1555 static const XColor *
1556 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1558 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1560 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1562 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1563 int i;
1565 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1566 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1567 dpyinfo->color_cells
1568 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1569 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1571 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1572 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1574 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1575 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1578 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1579 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1583 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1584 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1586 void
1587 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1589 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1591 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1593 int i;
1594 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1596 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1597 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1598 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1599 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1602 else
1603 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1607 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1608 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1610 void
1611 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1613 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1617 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1618 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1619 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1620 allocated. */
1622 static int
1623 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1625 int rc;
1627 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1628 if (rc == 0)
1630 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1631 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1632 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1633 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1634 int nearest, i;
1635 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1636 int ncells;
1637 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1639 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1641 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1642 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1643 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1644 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1646 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1648 nearest = i;
1649 nearest_delta = delta;
1653 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1654 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1655 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1656 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1658 else
1660 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1661 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1662 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1663 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1664 XColor *cached_color;
1666 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1667 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1668 (cached_color->red != color->red
1669 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1670 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1672 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1673 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1674 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1678 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1679 if (rc)
1680 register_color (color->pixel);
1681 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1683 return rc;
1687 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1688 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1689 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1690 allocated. */
1693 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1695 gamma_correct (f, color);
1696 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1700 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1701 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1702 get color reference counts right. */
1704 unsigned long
1705 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1707 XColor color;
1709 color.pixel = pixel;
1710 BLOCK_INPUT;
1711 x_query_color (f, &color);
1712 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1713 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1714 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1715 register_color (pixel);
1716 #endif
1717 return color.pixel;
1721 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1722 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1723 get color reference counts right. */
1725 unsigned long
1726 x_copy_dpy_color (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int pixel)
1728 XColor color;
1730 color.pixel = pixel;
1731 BLOCK_INPUT;
1732 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1733 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1734 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1735 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1736 register_color (pixel);
1737 #endif
1738 return color.pixel;
1742 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1743 boosted.
1745 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1746 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1747 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1748 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1749 use an additional additive factor.
1751 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1752 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1753 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1756 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1757 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1758 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1759 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1760 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1761 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1763 static int
1764 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1766 XColor color, new;
1767 long bright;
1768 int success_p;
1770 /* Get RGB color values. */
1771 color.pixel = *pixel;
1772 x_query_color (f, &color);
1774 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1775 xassert (factor >= 0);
1776 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1777 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1778 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1780 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1781 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1783 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1784 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1785 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1786 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1787 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1789 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1790 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1791 /* The additive adjustment. */
1792 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1794 if (factor < 1)
1796 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1797 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1798 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1800 else
1802 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1803 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1804 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1808 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1809 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1810 if (success_p)
1812 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1814 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1815 delta to the RGB values. */
1816 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1818 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1819 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1820 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1821 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1823 else
1824 success_p = 1;
1825 *pixel = new.pixel;
1828 return success_p;
1832 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1833 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1834 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1835 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1836 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1837 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1839 static void
1840 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1842 XGCValues xgcv;
1843 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1844 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1845 unsigned long pixel;
1846 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1847 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1848 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1849 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1851 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1852 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1854 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1855 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1856 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1857 if (relief->gc
1858 && relief->allocated_p)
1860 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1861 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1864 /* Allocate new color. */
1865 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1866 pixel = background;
1867 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1868 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1870 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1871 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1874 if (relief->gc == 0)
1876 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1877 mask |= GCStipple;
1878 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1880 else
1881 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1885 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1887 static void
1888 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1890 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1891 unsigned long color;
1893 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1894 color = s->face->box_color;
1895 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1896 && s->img->pixmap
1897 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1898 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1899 else
1901 XGCValues xgcv;
1903 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1904 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1905 color = xgcv.background;
1908 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1909 || color != di->relief_background)
1911 di->relief_background = color;
1912 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1913 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1914 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1915 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1920 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1921 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1922 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1923 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1924 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1925 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1926 when drawing. */
1928 static void
1929 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1930 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1931 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1932 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1934 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1935 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1936 int i;
1937 GC gc;
1939 if (raised_p)
1940 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1941 else
1942 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1943 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1945 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1946 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1947 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1948 corner pixels. */
1950 /* Top. */
1951 if (top_p)
1953 if (width == 1)
1954 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1955 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
1956 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
1958 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
1959 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1960 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
1961 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
1964 /* Left. */
1965 if (left_p)
1967 if (width == 1)
1968 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
1970 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
1971 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
1973 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
1974 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1975 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
1978 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
1979 if (raised_p)
1980 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1981 else
1982 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1983 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1985 if (width > 1)
1987 /* Outermost top line. */
1988 if (top_p)
1989 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1990 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
1991 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
1993 /* Outermost left line. */
1994 if (left_p)
1995 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
1998 /* Bottom. */
1999 if (bot_p)
2001 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2002 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2003 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2004 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2005 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2006 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2007 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2010 /* Right. */
2011 if (right_p)
2013 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2014 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2015 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2016 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2017 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2020 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2024 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2025 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2026 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2027 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2028 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2029 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2031 static void
2032 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2033 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2034 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2036 XGCValues xgcv;
2038 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2039 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2040 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2042 /* Top. */
2043 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2044 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2046 /* Left. */
2047 if (left_p)
2048 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2049 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2051 /* Bottom. */
2052 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2053 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2055 /* Right. */
2056 if (right_p)
2057 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2058 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2060 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2061 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2065 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2067 static void
2068 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2070 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2071 int left_p, right_p;
2072 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2073 XRectangle clip_rect;
2075 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2076 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2077 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2079 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2080 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2081 ? s->first_glyph
2082 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2084 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2085 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2086 left_x = s->x;
2087 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2088 ? last_x - 1
2089 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2090 top_y = s->y;
2091 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2093 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2094 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2095 && (s->prev == NULL
2096 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2097 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2098 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2099 && (s->next == NULL
2100 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2102 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2104 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2105 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2106 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2107 else
2109 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2110 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2111 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2116 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2118 static void
2119 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2121 int x = s->x;
2122 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2124 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2125 right of that line. */
2126 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2127 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2128 && s->slice.x == 0)
2129 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2131 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2132 by that margin. */
2133 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2134 x += s->img->hmargin;
2135 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2136 y += s->img->vmargin;
2138 if (s->img->pixmap)
2140 if (s->img->mask)
2142 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2143 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2144 trust on the shape extension to be available
2145 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2146 manually. */
2147 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2148 | GCFunction);
2149 XGCValues xgcv;
2150 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2152 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2153 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2154 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2155 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2156 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2158 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2159 image_rect.x = x;
2160 image_rect.y = y;
2161 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2162 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2163 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2164 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2165 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2166 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2168 else
2170 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2172 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2173 image_rect.x = x;
2174 image_rect.y = y;
2175 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2176 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2177 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2178 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2179 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2180 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2182 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2183 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2184 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2185 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2186 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2187 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2188 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2190 int r = s->img->relief;
2191 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2192 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2193 x - r, y - r,
2194 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2195 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2199 else
2200 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2201 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2202 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2206 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2208 static void
2209 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2211 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2212 XRectangle r;
2213 int x = s->x;
2214 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2216 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2217 right of that line. */
2218 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2219 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2220 && s->slice.x == 0)
2221 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2223 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2224 by that margin. */
2225 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2226 x += s->img->hmargin;
2227 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2228 y += s->img->vmargin;
2230 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2231 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2233 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2234 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2236 else
2238 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2239 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2242 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2243 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2245 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2246 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2247 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2248 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2250 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2251 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2252 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2253 s->slice.y == 0,
2254 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2255 s->slice.x == 0,
2256 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2257 &r);
2261 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2263 static void
2264 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2266 int x = 0;
2267 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2269 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2270 right of that line. */
2271 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2272 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2273 && s->slice.x == 0)
2274 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2276 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2277 by that margin. */
2278 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2279 x += s->img->hmargin;
2280 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2281 y += s->img->vmargin;
2283 if (s->img->pixmap)
2285 if (s->img->mask)
2287 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2288 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2289 trust on the shape extension to be available
2290 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2291 manually. */
2292 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2293 | GCFunction);
2294 XGCValues xgcv;
2296 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2297 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2298 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2299 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2300 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2302 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2303 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2304 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2305 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2307 else
2309 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2310 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2311 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2313 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2314 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2315 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2316 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2317 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2318 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2319 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2321 int r = s->img->relief;
2322 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2323 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2324 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2325 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2329 else
2330 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2331 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2332 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2336 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2337 give the rectangle to draw. */
2339 static void
2340 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2342 if (s->stippled_p)
2344 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2345 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2346 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2347 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2349 else
2350 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2354 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2356 s->y
2357 s->x +-------------------------
2358 | s->face->box
2360 | +-------------------------
2361 | | s->img->margin
2363 | | +-------------------
2364 | | | the image
2368 static void
2369 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2371 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2372 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2373 int height;
2374 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2376 height = s->height;
2377 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2378 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2379 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2380 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2382 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2383 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2384 flickering. */
2385 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2386 if (height > s->slice.height
2387 || s->img->hmargin
2388 || s->img->vmargin
2389 || s->img->mask
2390 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2391 || s->width != s->background_width)
2393 if (s->img->mask)
2395 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2396 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2397 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2398 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2399 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2401 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2402 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2403 s->background_width,
2404 s->height, depth);
2406 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2407 pixmap. */
2408 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2410 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2411 if (s->stippled_p)
2413 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2414 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2415 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2416 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2417 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2418 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2419 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2421 else
2423 XGCValues xgcv;
2424 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2425 &xgcv);
2426 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2427 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2428 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2429 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2432 else
2434 int x = s->x;
2435 int y = s->y;
2437 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2438 && s->slice.x == 0)
2439 x += box_line_hwidth;
2441 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2442 y += box_line_vwidth;
2444 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2447 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2450 /* Draw the foreground. */
2451 if (pixmap != None)
2453 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2454 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2455 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2456 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2457 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2459 else
2460 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2462 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2463 if (s->img->relief
2464 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2465 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2466 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2470 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2472 static void
2473 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2475 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2477 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2478 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2480 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2481 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2482 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2483 int x = s->x;
2485 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2487 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2489 if (x < left_x)
2491 background_width -= left_x - x;
2492 x = left_x;
2495 else
2497 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2498 stretch glyph. */
2499 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2501 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2502 background_width -= x - right_x;
2503 x += background_width;
2505 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2506 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2507 x -= width;
2509 /* Draw cursor. */
2510 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2512 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2513 if (width < background_width)
2515 int y = s->y;
2516 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2517 XRectangle r;
2518 GC gc;
2520 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2521 x += width;
2522 else
2523 x = s->x;
2524 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2525 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2527 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2528 gc = s->gc;
2530 else
2531 gc = s->face->gc;
2533 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2534 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2536 if (s->face->stipple)
2538 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2539 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2540 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2541 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2543 else
2545 XGCValues xgcv;
2546 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2547 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2548 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2549 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2553 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2555 int background_width = s->background_width;
2556 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2558 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2559 except for header line and mode line. */
2560 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2562 background_width -= left_x - x;
2563 x = left_x;
2565 if (background_width > 0)
2566 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2569 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2573 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2575 static void
2576 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2578 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2580 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2581 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2582 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2583 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2585 int width;
2586 struct glyph_string *next;
2588 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2589 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2590 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2591 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2593 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2594 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2595 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2596 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2597 else
2598 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2599 next->num_clips = 0;
2603 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2604 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2606 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2607 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2608 if (!s->for_overlaps
2609 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2610 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2611 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2614 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2615 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2616 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2617 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2618 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2620 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2621 && !s->clip_tail
2622 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2623 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2624 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2625 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2626 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2627 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2628 else
2629 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2631 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2633 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2634 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2635 break;
2637 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2638 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2639 break;
2641 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2642 if (s->for_overlaps)
2643 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2644 else
2645 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2646 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2647 break;
2649 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2650 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2651 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2652 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2653 else
2654 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2655 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2656 break;
2658 default:
2659 abort ();
2662 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2664 /* Draw underline. */
2665 if (s->face->underline_p)
2667 unsigned long thickness, position;
2668 int y;
2670 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2672 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2673 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2674 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2676 else
2678 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2679 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2680 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2681 else
2682 thickness = 1;
2683 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2684 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2685 else
2687 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2688 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2689 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2690 specs, and its default is
2692 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2693 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2695 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2696 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2697 position = s->font->underline_position;
2698 else if (s->font)
2699 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2700 else
2701 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2703 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2705 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2706 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2707 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2708 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2709 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2710 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2711 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2712 s->underline_position = position;
2713 y = s->ybase + position;
2714 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2715 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2716 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2717 else
2719 XGCValues xgcv;
2720 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2721 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2722 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2723 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2724 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2728 /* Draw overline. */
2729 if (s->face->overline_p)
2731 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2733 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2734 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2735 s->width, h);
2736 else
2738 XGCValues xgcv;
2739 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2740 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2741 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2742 s->width, h);
2743 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2747 /* Draw strike-through. */
2748 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2750 unsigned long h = 1;
2751 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2753 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2754 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2755 s->width, h);
2756 else
2758 XGCValues xgcv;
2759 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2760 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2761 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2762 s->width, h);
2763 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2767 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2768 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2769 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2771 if (s->prev)
2773 struct glyph_string *prev;
2775 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2776 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2777 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2779 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2780 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2781 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2783 prev->hl = s->hl;
2784 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2785 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2786 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2787 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2788 else
2789 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2790 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2791 prev->hl = save;
2792 prev->num_clips = 0;
2796 if (s->next)
2798 struct glyph_string *next;
2800 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2801 if (next->hl != s->hl
2802 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2804 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2805 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2806 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2808 next->hl = s->hl;
2809 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2810 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2811 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2812 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2813 else
2814 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2815 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2816 next->hl = save;
2817 next->num_clips = 0;
2822 /* Reset clipping. */
2823 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2824 s->num_clips = 0;
2827 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2829 void
2830 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2832 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2833 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2834 x, y, width, height,
2835 x + shift_by, y);
2838 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2839 for X frames. */
2841 static void
2842 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2844 abort ();
2848 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2849 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2851 void
2852 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2854 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2855 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2859 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2861 static void
2862 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2864 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2865 longer visible. */
2866 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2867 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2868 output_cursor.x = -1;
2870 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2871 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2872 BLOCK_INPUT;
2873 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2875 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2876 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2877 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2879 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2880 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2881 redisplay, do it here. */
2882 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2883 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2884 #endif
2886 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2888 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2893 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2895 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2896 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2898 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2901 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2902 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2904 static int
2905 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2907 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2908 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2909 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2911 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2912 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2913 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2916 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2918 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2919 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2920 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2923 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2924 positive. */
2925 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2926 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2928 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2929 negative. */
2930 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2933 void
2934 XTflash (struct frame *f)
2936 BLOCK_INPUT;
2939 #ifdef USE_GTK
2940 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
2941 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
2942 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2943 GdkGCValues vals;
2944 GdkGC *gc;
2945 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
2946 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
2947 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
2948 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
2949 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
2950 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
2951 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
2952 #else
2953 GC gc;
2955 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2956 pixels into background pixels. */
2958 XGCValues values;
2960 values.function = GXxor;
2961 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
2962 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
2964 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2965 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2967 #endif
2969 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2970 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2971 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2972 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2973 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2974 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2975 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2977 int width;
2979 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2980 edge it is next to. */
2981 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2983 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2984 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2985 break;
2987 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2988 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2989 break;
2991 default:
2992 break;
2995 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2997 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2998 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3000 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3001 flash_left,
3002 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3003 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3004 width, flash_height);
3005 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3006 flash_left,
3007 (height - flash_height
3008 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3009 width, flash_height);
3012 else
3013 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3014 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3015 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3016 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3018 x_flush (f);
3021 struct timeval wakeup;
3023 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3025 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3026 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3027 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3028 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3030 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3031 available. */
3032 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3034 struct timeval current;
3035 struct timeval timeout;
3037 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3039 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3040 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3041 break;
3043 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3044 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3045 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3047 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3048 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3052 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3053 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3055 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3056 flash_left,
3057 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3058 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3059 width, flash_height);
3060 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3061 flash_left,
3062 (height - flash_height
3063 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3064 width, flash_height);
3066 else
3067 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3068 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3069 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3070 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3072 #ifdef USE_GTK
3073 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3074 #undef XFillRectangle
3075 #else
3076 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3077 #endif
3078 x_flush (f);
3082 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3085 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3088 static void
3089 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3091 BLOCK_INPUT;
3092 if (invisible)
3094 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3095 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3096 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3098 else
3099 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3100 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3101 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3102 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3106 /* Make audible bell. */
3108 void
3109 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3111 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3113 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3114 if (visible_bell)
3115 XTflash (f);
3116 else
3117 #endif
3119 BLOCK_INPUT;
3120 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3121 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3122 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3128 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3129 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3130 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3131 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3133 static void
3134 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3136 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3141 /***********************************************************************
3142 Line Dance
3143 ***********************************************************************/
3145 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3146 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3148 static void
3149 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3151 abort ();
3155 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3157 static void
3158 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3160 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3161 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3163 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3164 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3165 fringe of W. */
3166 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3168 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3169 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3170 bottom_y = y + height;
3172 if (to_y < from_y)
3174 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3175 line at the bottom. */
3176 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3177 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3178 else
3179 height = run->height;
3181 else
3183 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3184 at the bottom. */
3185 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3186 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3187 else
3188 height = run->height;
3191 BLOCK_INPUT;
3193 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3194 updated_window = w;
3195 x_clear_cursor (w);
3197 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3198 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3199 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3200 x, from_y,
3201 width, height,
3202 x, to_y);
3204 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3209 /***********************************************************************
3210 Exposure Events
3211 ***********************************************************************/
3214 static void
3215 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3217 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3218 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3219 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3220 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3221 BLOCK_INPUT;
3222 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3223 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3224 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3225 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3226 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3229 static void
3230 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3232 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3233 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3234 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3235 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3236 BLOCK_INPUT;
3237 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3238 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3239 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3240 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3241 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3244 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3245 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3246 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3247 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3248 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3250 static void
3251 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3253 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3255 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3257 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3258 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3259 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3261 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3262 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3264 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3265 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3266 else
3267 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3270 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3273 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3274 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3275 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3277 static void
3278 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3280 if (type == FocusIn)
3282 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3284 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3285 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3287 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3288 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3289 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3290 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3291 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3293 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3294 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3298 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3300 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3301 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3302 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3303 #endif
3305 else if (type == FocusOut)
3307 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3309 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3311 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3312 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3315 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3316 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3317 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3318 #endif
3319 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3320 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3324 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3325 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3327 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3329 static void
3330 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3332 struct frame *frame;
3334 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3335 if (! frame)
3336 return;
3338 switch (event->type)
3340 case EnterNotify:
3341 case LeaveNotify:
3343 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3344 int focus_state
3345 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3347 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3348 && event->xcrossing.focus
3349 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3350 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3351 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3352 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3354 break;
3356 case FocusIn:
3357 case FocusOut:
3358 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3359 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3360 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3361 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3362 break;
3364 case ClientMessage:
3365 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3367 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3368 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3369 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3371 break;
3376 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3378 void
3379 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3381 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3384 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3385 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3386 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3388 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3389 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3390 the appropriate X display info. */
3392 static void
3393 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3395 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3398 static void
3399 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3401 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3403 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3405 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3406 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3407 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3408 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3409 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3411 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3412 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3415 else
3416 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3418 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3420 if (old_highlight)
3421 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3422 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3423 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3429 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3431 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3432 static void
3433 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3435 int min_code, max_code;
3436 KeySym *syms;
3437 int syms_per_code;
3438 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3440 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3441 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3442 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3443 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3444 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3446 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3448 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3449 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3450 &syms_per_code);
3451 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3453 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3454 Alt keysyms are on. */
3456 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3457 int found_alt_or_meta;
3459 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3461 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3462 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3464 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3466 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3467 if (code == 0)
3468 continue;
3470 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3472 int code_col;
3474 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3476 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3478 switch (sym)
3480 case XK_Meta_L:
3481 case XK_Meta_R:
3482 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3483 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3484 break;
3486 case XK_Alt_L:
3487 case XK_Alt_R:
3488 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3489 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3490 break;
3492 case XK_Hyper_L:
3493 case XK_Hyper_R:
3494 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3495 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3496 code_col = syms_per_code;
3497 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3498 break;
3500 case XK_Super_L:
3501 case XK_Super_R:
3502 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3503 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3504 code_col = syms_per_code;
3505 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3506 break;
3508 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3509 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3510 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3511 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3512 code_col = syms_per_code;
3513 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3514 break;
3522 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3523 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3525 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3526 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3529 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3530 make them just meta, not alt. */
3531 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3533 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3536 XFree ((char *) syms);
3537 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3540 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3541 Emacs uses. */
3543 unsigned int
3544 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3546 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3547 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3548 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3549 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3550 Lisp_Object tem;
3552 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3553 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3554 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3555 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3556 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3557 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3558 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3559 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3562 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3563 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3564 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3565 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3566 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3567 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3570 static unsigned int
3571 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3573 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3574 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3575 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3576 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3578 Lisp_Object tem;
3580 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3581 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3582 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3583 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3584 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3585 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3586 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3587 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3590 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3591 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3592 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3593 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3594 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3595 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3598 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3600 char *
3601 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3603 char *value;
3605 BLOCK_INPUT;
3606 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3607 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3609 return value;
3614 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3616 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3618 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3619 the mouse. */
3621 static Lisp_Object
3622 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3624 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3625 otherwise. */
3626 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3627 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3628 result->timestamp = event->time;
3629 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3630 event->state)
3631 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3632 ? up_modifier
3633 : down_modifier));
3635 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3636 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3637 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3638 result->arg = Qnil;
3639 return Qnil;
3643 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3644 The input handler calls this.
3646 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3647 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3648 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3649 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3651 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3652 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3654 static int
3655 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3657 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3658 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3659 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3661 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3662 return 0;
3664 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3666 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3667 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3668 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3669 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3670 return 1;
3674 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3675 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3676 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3677 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3678 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3679 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3681 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3682 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3683 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3684 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3685 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3686 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3687 return 1;
3690 return 0;
3694 /************************************************************************
3695 Mouse Face
3696 ************************************************************************/
3698 static void
3699 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3701 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3702 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3703 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3704 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3705 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3710 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3711 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3713 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3714 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3715 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3716 position on the scroll bar.
3718 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3719 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3720 the mouse is over.
3722 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3723 was at this position.
3725 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3727 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3728 movement. */
3730 static void
3731 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
3733 FRAME_PTR f1;
3735 BLOCK_INPUT;
3737 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3738 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3739 else
3741 Window root;
3742 int root_x, root_y;
3744 Window dummy_window;
3745 int dummy;
3747 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3749 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3750 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3751 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3752 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3753 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3755 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3757 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3758 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3759 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3761 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3762 &root,
3764 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3765 a different screen. */
3766 &dummy_window,
3768 /* The position on that root window. */
3769 &root_x, &root_y,
3771 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3772 &dummy, &dummy,
3774 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3775 we don't care. */
3776 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3778 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3779 containing the pointer. */
3781 Window win, child;
3782 int win_x, win_y;
3783 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3785 win = root;
3787 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3788 structure is changing at the same time this function
3789 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3791 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3793 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3794 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3796 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3797 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3798 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3800 /* From-window, to-window. */
3801 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3803 /* From-position, to-position. */
3804 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3806 /* Child of win. */
3807 &child);
3808 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3810 else
3812 while (1)
3814 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3816 /* From-window, to-window. */
3817 root, win,
3819 /* From-position, to-position. */
3820 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3822 /* Child of win. */
3823 &child);
3825 if (child == None || child == win)
3826 break;
3827 #ifdef USE_GTK
3828 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3829 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3830 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3831 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3832 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3833 break;
3834 #endif
3835 win = child;
3836 parent_x = win_x;
3837 parent_y = win_y;
3840 /* Now we know that:
3841 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3842 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3843 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3844 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3845 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3846 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3847 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3848 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3849 never use them in that case.) */
3851 #ifdef USE_GTK
3852 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3853 want the edit window. */
3854 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3855 #else
3856 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3857 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3858 #endif
3860 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3861 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3862 on the frame. */
3863 if (f1 != NULL
3864 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3865 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3866 f1 = NULL;
3867 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3870 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3871 f1 = 0;
3873 x_uncatch_errors ();
3875 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3876 if (! f1)
3878 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3880 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3882 if (bar)
3884 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3885 win_x = parent_x;
3886 win_y = parent_y;
3890 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3891 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3893 if (f1)
3895 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3896 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3897 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3898 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3899 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3900 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3901 the frame are divided into. */
3903 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3904 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3906 *bar_window = Qnil;
3907 *part = 0;
3908 *fp = f1;
3909 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3910 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3911 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3916 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3921 /***********************************************************************
3922 Scroll bars
3923 ***********************************************************************/
3925 /* Scroll bar support. */
3927 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3928 manages it.
3929 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3930 bits. */
3932 static struct scroll_bar *
3933 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
3935 Lisp_Object tail;
3937 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3938 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3939 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3941 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3943 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3945 frame = XCAR (tail);
3946 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3947 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
3948 abort ();
3950 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
3951 continue;
3953 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3954 right window ID. */
3955 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3956 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3957 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3958 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3959 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3960 condemned = Qnil,
3961 ! NILP (bar));
3962 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3963 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
3964 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3965 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3968 return 0;
3972 #if defined USE_LUCID
3974 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3975 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3977 static Widget
3978 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
3980 Lisp_Object tail;
3982 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3984 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
3986 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3987 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3989 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3990 return menu_bar;
3994 return NULL;
3997 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4000 /************************************************************************
4001 Toolkit scroll bars
4002 ************************************************************************/
4004 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4006 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4007 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4008 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4009 struct scroll_bar *);
4010 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4011 int, int, int);
4014 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4015 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4017 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4019 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4021 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4023 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4024 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4026 #ifndef USE_GTK
4027 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4029 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4031 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4033 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4034 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4035 to avoid jerkyness. */
4037 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4039 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4040 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4041 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4042 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4044 static void
4045 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4046 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4048 int scroll_bar_p;
4049 const char *end_action;
4051 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4052 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4053 end_action = "Release";
4054 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4055 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4056 end_action = "EndScroll";
4057 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4059 if (scroll_bar_p
4060 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4061 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4063 struct window *w;
4065 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4066 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4067 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4069 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4071 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4072 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4073 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4075 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4076 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4078 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4079 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4082 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4084 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4085 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4087 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4088 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4091 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4092 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4093 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4094 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4096 static void
4097 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4099 XEvent event;
4100 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4101 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4102 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4103 int i;
4105 BLOCK_INPUT;
4107 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4108 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4109 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4110 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4111 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4112 ev->format = 32;
4114 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4115 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4116 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4117 into that array in the event. */
4118 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4119 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4120 break;
4122 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4124 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4125 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4126 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4128 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4129 nbytes);
4130 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4131 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4134 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4135 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4136 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4137 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4138 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4139 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4141 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4142 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4143 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4144 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4145 #endif
4147 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4148 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4149 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4150 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4151 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4155 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4156 in *IEVENT. */
4158 static void
4159 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4161 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4162 Lisp_Object window;
4163 struct frame *f;
4164 struct window *w;
4166 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4167 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4169 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4170 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4172 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4173 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4174 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4175 #ifdef USE_GTK
4176 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4177 #else
4178 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4179 #endif
4180 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4181 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4182 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4183 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4184 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4188 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4190 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4192 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4195 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4196 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4197 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4199 static void
4200 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4202 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4203 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4204 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4206 switch (cs->reason)
4208 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4209 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4210 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4211 break;
4213 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4214 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4215 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4216 break;
4218 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4219 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4220 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4221 break;
4223 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4224 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4225 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4226 break;
4228 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4229 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4230 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4231 break;
4233 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4234 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4235 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4236 break;
4238 case XmCR_DRAG:
4240 int slider_size;
4242 /* Get the slider size. */
4243 BLOCK_INPUT;
4244 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4245 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4247 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4248 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4249 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4250 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4252 break;
4254 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4255 break;
4258 if (part >= 0)
4260 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4261 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4262 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4266 #elif defined USE_GTK
4268 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4269 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4271 static gboolean
4272 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4273 GtkScrollType scroll,
4274 gdouble value,
4275 gpointer user_data)
4277 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4278 gdouble position;
4279 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4280 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4281 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4283 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4284 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4287 switch (scroll)
4289 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4290 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4291 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4292 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4294 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4295 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4296 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4297 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4298 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4300 break;
4301 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4302 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4303 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4304 break;
4305 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4306 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4307 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4308 break;
4309 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4310 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4311 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4312 break;
4313 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4314 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4315 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4316 break;
4319 if (part >= 0)
4321 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4322 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4323 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4326 return FALSE;
4329 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4331 static gboolean
4332 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4333 GdkEventButton *event,
4334 gpointer user_data)
4336 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4337 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4338 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4340 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4341 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4342 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4345 return FALSE;
4349 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4351 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4352 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4353 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4354 the thumb is. */
4356 static void
4357 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4359 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4360 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4361 float shown;
4362 int whole, portion, height;
4363 int part;
4365 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4366 BLOCK_INPUT;
4367 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4368 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4370 whole = 10000000;
4371 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4373 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4374 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4375 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4376 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4377 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4378 bottom). */
4379 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4380 else
4381 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4383 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4384 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4385 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4386 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4390 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4391 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4392 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4393 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4394 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4395 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4396 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4398 static void
4399 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4401 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4402 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4403 int position = (long) call_data;
4404 Dimension height;
4405 int part;
4407 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4408 BLOCK_INPUT;
4409 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4410 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4412 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4413 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4415 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4416 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4417 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4418 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4419 else
4420 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4422 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4423 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4424 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4425 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4428 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4430 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4432 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4433 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4435 #ifdef USE_GTK
4436 static void
4437 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4439 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4441 BLOCK_INPUT;
4442 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4443 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4444 scroll_bar_name);
4445 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4448 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4450 static void
4451 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4453 Window xwindow;
4454 Widget widget;
4455 Arg av[20];
4456 int ac = 0;
4457 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4458 unsigned long pixel;
4460 BLOCK_INPUT;
4462 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4463 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4464 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4465 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4466 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4467 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4468 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4469 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4470 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4472 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4473 if (pixel != -1)
4475 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4476 ++ac;
4479 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4480 if (pixel != -1)
4482 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4483 ++ac;
4486 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4487 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4489 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4490 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4491 (XtPointer) bar);
4492 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4493 (XtPointer) bar);
4494 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4495 (XtPointer) bar);
4496 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4497 (XtPointer) bar);
4498 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4499 (XtPointer) bar);
4500 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4501 (XtPointer) bar);
4502 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4503 (XtPointer) bar);
4505 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4506 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4508 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4509 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4510 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4511 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4513 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4515 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4516 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4517 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4518 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4519 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4520 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4521 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4522 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4524 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4525 if (pixel != -1)
4527 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4528 ++ac;
4531 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4532 if (pixel != -1)
4534 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4535 ++ac;
4538 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4540 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4541 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4543 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4544 if (pixel != -1)
4546 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4547 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4548 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4549 pixel = -1;
4550 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4553 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4555 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4556 if (pixel != -1)
4558 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4559 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4560 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4561 pixel = -1;
4562 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4566 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4567 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4568 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4569 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4570 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4571 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4572 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4573 colors itself. */
4575 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4576 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4577 ++ac;
4579 else
4580 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4581 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4582 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4584 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4585 the shadows. */
4586 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4587 ++ac;
4589 /* Specify the colors. */
4590 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4591 if (pixel != -1)
4593 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4594 ++ac;
4596 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4597 if (pixel != -1)
4599 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4600 ++ac;
4603 #endif
4605 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4606 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4609 char *initial = "";
4610 char *val = initial;
4611 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4612 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4613 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4614 #endif
4615 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4616 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4617 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4618 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4619 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4620 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4624 /* Define callbacks. */
4625 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4626 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4627 (XtPointer) bar);
4629 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4630 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4632 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4634 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4635 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4636 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4637 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4639 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4640 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4641 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4642 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4644 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4646 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4649 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4650 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4652 #ifdef USE_GTK
4653 static void
4654 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4656 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4659 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4660 static void
4661 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4662 int whole)
4664 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4665 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4666 float top, shown;
4668 BLOCK_INPUT;
4670 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4672 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4673 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4674 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4675 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4676 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4677 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4678 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4679 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4680 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4681 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4682 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4683 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4684 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4685 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4686 whole += portion;
4688 if (whole <= 0)
4689 top = 0, shown = 1;
4690 else
4692 top = (float) position / whole;
4693 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4696 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4698 int size, value;
4700 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4701 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4702 value. */
4703 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4704 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4705 size = max (size, 1);
4707 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4708 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4709 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4711 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4713 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4715 if (whole == 0)
4716 top = 0, shown = 1;
4717 else
4719 top = (float) position / whole;
4720 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4724 float old_top, old_shown;
4725 Dimension height;
4726 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4727 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4728 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4729 XtNheight, &height,
4730 NULL);
4732 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4733 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4734 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4735 else
4736 top = old_top;
4737 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4738 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4740 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4741 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4742 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4743 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4745 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4746 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4747 else
4749 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4750 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4751 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4753 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4757 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4759 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4761 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4763 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4767 /************************************************************************
4768 Scroll bars, general
4769 ************************************************************************/
4771 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4772 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4773 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4774 scroll bar. */
4776 static struct scroll_bar *
4777 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4779 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4780 struct scroll_bar *bar
4781 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4783 BLOCK_INPUT;
4785 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4786 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4787 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4789 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4790 unsigned long mask;
4791 Window window;
4793 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4794 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4795 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4797 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4798 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4799 | ExposureMask);
4800 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4802 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4804 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4805 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4806 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4807 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4808 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4809 left, top, width,
4810 window_box_height (w), False);
4812 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4813 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4814 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4815 top,
4816 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4817 height,
4818 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4820 CopyFromParent,
4821 CopyFromParent,
4822 CopyFromParent,
4823 /* Attributes. */
4824 mask, &a);
4825 bar->x_window = window;
4827 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4829 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4830 bar->top = top;
4831 bar->left = left;
4832 bar->width = width;
4833 bar->height = height;
4834 bar->start = 0;
4835 bar->end = 0;
4836 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4837 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4839 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4840 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4841 bar->prev = Qnil;
4842 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4843 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4844 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4846 /* Map the window/widget. */
4847 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4849 #ifdef USE_GTK
4850 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4851 bar->x_window,
4852 top,
4853 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4854 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4855 max (height, 1));
4856 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4857 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4858 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4859 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4860 top,
4861 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4862 max (height, 1), 0);
4863 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4864 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4866 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4867 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4868 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4870 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4871 return bar;
4875 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4877 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4879 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4880 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4881 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4882 events.)
4884 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4885 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4886 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4887 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4888 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4890 static void
4891 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
4893 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4894 Window w = bar->x_window;
4895 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4896 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4898 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4899 if (! rebuild
4900 && start == bar->start
4901 && end == bar->end)
4902 return;
4904 BLOCK_INPUT;
4907 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
4908 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
4909 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
4911 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4912 the distance between start and end. */
4914 int length = end - start;
4916 if (start < 0)
4917 start = 0;
4918 else if (start > top_range)
4919 start = top_range;
4920 end = start + length;
4922 if (end < start)
4923 end = start;
4924 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4925 end = top_range;
4928 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4929 bar->start = start;
4930 bar->end = end;
4932 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4933 if (end > top_range)
4934 end = top_range;
4936 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4937 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4938 that many pixels tall. */
4939 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4941 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4942 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4943 if (0 < start)
4944 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4945 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4946 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4947 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4948 inside_width, start,
4949 False);
4951 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4952 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4953 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4954 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4956 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4957 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4958 /* x, y, width, height */
4959 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4960 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4961 inside_width, end - start);
4963 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4964 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4965 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4966 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
4968 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4969 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4970 if (end < inside_height)
4971 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4972 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4973 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4974 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4975 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4976 False);
4980 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4983 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4985 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4986 nil. */
4988 static void
4989 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
4991 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4992 BLOCK_INPUT;
4994 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4995 #ifdef USE_GTK
4996 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
4997 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4998 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4999 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5000 #else
5001 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5002 #endif
5004 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5005 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5007 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5011 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5012 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5013 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5014 create one. */
5016 static void
5017 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5019 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5020 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5021 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5022 int window_y, window_height;
5023 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5024 int fringe_extended_p;
5025 #endif
5027 /* Get window dimensions. */
5028 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5029 top = window_y;
5030 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5031 height = window_height;
5033 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5034 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5036 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5037 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5038 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5039 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5040 else
5041 sb_width = width;
5043 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5044 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5045 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5046 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5047 else
5048 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5049 #else
5050 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5051 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5052 else
5053 sb_left = left;
5054 #endif
5056 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5057 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5058 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5059 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5060 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5061 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5062 else
5063 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5064 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5065 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5066 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5067 #endif
5069 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5070 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5072 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5074 BLOCK_INPUT;
5075 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5076 if (fringe_extended_p)
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5079 else
5080 #endif
5081 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5082 left, top, width, height, False);
5083 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5086 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5088 else
5090 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5091 unsigned int mask = 0;
5093 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5095 BLOCK_INPUT;
5097 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5098 mask |= CWX;
5099 if (top != bar->top)
5100 mask |= CWY;
5101 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5102 mask |= CWWidth;
5103 if (height != bar->height)
5104 mask |= CWHeight;
5106 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5108 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5109 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5111 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5112 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5113 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5115 if (fringe_extended_p)
5116 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5117 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5118 else
5119 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5120 left, top, width, height, False);
5122 #ifdef USE_GTK
5123 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5124 bar->x_window,
5125 top,
5126 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5127 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5128 max (height, 1));
5129 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5130 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5131 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5132 top,
5133 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5134 max (height, 1), 0);
5135 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5137 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5139 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5140 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5141 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5143 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5144 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5145 height, False);
5146 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5147 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5148 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5149 height, False);
5152 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5153 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5154 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5155 example. */
5157 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5158 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5159 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5161 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5162 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5163 left + area_width - rest, top,
5164 rest, height, False);
5165 else
5166 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5167 left, top, rest, height, False);
5171 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5172 if (mask)
5174 XWindowChanges wc;
5176 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5177 wc.y = top;
5178 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5179 wc.height = height;
5180 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5181 mask, &wc);
5184 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5186 /* Remember new settings. */
5187 bar->left = sb_left;
5188 bar->top = top;
5189 bar->width = sb_width;
5190 bar->height = height;
5192 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5195 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5196 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5198 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5199 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5200 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5201 dragged. */
5202 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5204 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5206 if (whole == 0)
5207 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5208 else
5210 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5211 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5212 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5215 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5217 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5221 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5222 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5223 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5224 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5225 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5226 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5227 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5229 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5230 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5231 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5233 static void
5234 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5236 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5237 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5239 Lisp_Object bar;
5240 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5241 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5242 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5243 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5244 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5245 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5246 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5251 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5252 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5254 static void
5255 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5257 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5258 struct frame *f;
5260 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5261 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5262 abort ();
5264 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5266 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5267 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5268 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5270 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5271 the lists. */
5272 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5273 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5274 return;
5275 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5276 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5277 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5278 else
5279 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5280 one or the other! */
5281 abort ();
5283 else
5284 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5286 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5287 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5289 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5290 bar->prev = Qnil;
5291 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5292 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5293 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5296 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5297 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5299 static void
5300 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5302 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5304 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5306 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5307 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5308 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5310 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5312 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5314 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5316 next = b->next;
5317 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5320 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5321 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5325 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5326 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5327 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5329 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5330 mark bits. */
5332 static void
5333 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5335 Window w = bar->x_window;
5336 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5337 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5338 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5340 BLOCK_INPUT;
5342 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5344 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5345 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5346 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5347 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5349 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5350 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5352 /* x, y, width, height */
5353 0, 0,
5354 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5355 bar->height - 1);
5357 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5358 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5359 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5360 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5362 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5365 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5367 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5368 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5370 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5371 mark bits. */
5374 static void
5375 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5377 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5378 abort ();
5380 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5381 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5382 emacs_event->modifiers
5383 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5384 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5385 event->xbutton.state)
5386 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5387 ? up_modifier
5388 : down_modifier));
5389 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5390 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5391 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5393 int top_range
5394 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5395 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5397 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5398 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5400 if (y < bar->start)
5401 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5402 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5403 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5404 else
5405 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5407 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5408 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5409 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5410 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5412 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5413 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5415 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5416 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5418 #endif
5420 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5421 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5425 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5427 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5429 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5430 mark bits. */
5432 static void
5433 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5435 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5437 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5439 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5440 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5442 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5443 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5445 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5446 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5448 if (new_start != bar->start)
5450 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5452 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5457 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5459 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5460 on the scroll bar. */
5462 static void
5463 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
5465 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5466 Window w = bar->x_window;
5467 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5468 int win_x, win_y;
5469 Window dummy_window;
5470 int dummy_coord;
5471 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5473 BLOCK_INPUT;
5475 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5476 report that. */
5477 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5479 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5480 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5481 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5483 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5484 &win_x, &win_y,
5486 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5487 &dummy_mask))
5489 else
5491 int top_range
5492 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5494 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5496 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5497 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5499 if (win_y < 0)
5500 win_y = 0;
5501 if (win_y > top_range)
5502 win_y = top_range;
5504 *fp = f;
5505 *bar_window = bar->window;
5507 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5508 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5509 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5510 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5511 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5512 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5513 else
5514 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5516 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5517 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5519 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5520 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5523 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5525 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5529 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5530 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5531 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5532 redraw them. */
5534 void
5535 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5537 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5538 Lisp_Object bar;
5540 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5541 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5542 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5543 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5544 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5545 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5546 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5547 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5548 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5549 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5553 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5555 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5556 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5557 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5558 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5560 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5561 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5563 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5565 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5566 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5568 static int temp_index;
5569 static short temp_buffer[100];
5571 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5572 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5573 temp_index = 0; \
5574 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5576 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5577 on a particular display. */
5579 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5581 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5582 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5583 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5584 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5586 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5588 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5589 do \
5591 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5592 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5593 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5594 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5595 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5596 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5598 while (0)
5600 enum
5602 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5603 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5604 X_EVENT_DROP
5607 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5608 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5609 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5611 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5612 this event further.
5613 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5615 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5616 static int
5617 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5619 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5620 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5621 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5622 was created. */
5624 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5625 event->xclient.window);
5627 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5629 #endif
5631 #ifdef USE_GTK
5632 static int current_count;
5633 static int current_finish;
5634 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5636 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5637 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5638 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5639 static GdkFilterReturn
5640 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5642 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5644 BLOCK_INPUT;
5645 if (current_count >= 0)
5647 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5649 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5651 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5652 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5653 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5654 so we do it here. */
5655 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5656 && dpyinfo
5657 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5659 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5660 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5662 #endif
5664 if (! dpyinfo)
5665 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5666 else
5667 current_count +=
5668 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5669 current_hold_quit);
5671 else
5672 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5674 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5676 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5677 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5679 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5681 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5684 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5686 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5687 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5688 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5690 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5692 static int
5693 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventp, int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5695 union {
5696 struct input_event ie;
5697 struct selection_input_event sie;
5698 } inev;
5699 int count = 0;
5700 int do_help = 0;
5701 int nbytes = 0;
5702 struct frame *f = NULL;
5703 struct coding_system coding;
5704 XEvent event = *eventp;
5706 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5708 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5709 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5710 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5712 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5713 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5715 switch (event.type)
5717 case ClientMessage:
5719 if (event.xclient.message_type
5720 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5721 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5723 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5724 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5726 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5727 could be the shell widget window
5728 if the frame has no title bar. */
5729 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5730 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5731 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5732 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5733 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5734 #endif
5735 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5736 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5737 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5738 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5739 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5740 needed.
5742 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5743 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5744 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5745 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5746 Emacs. */
5748 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5749 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5750 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5751 if (f)
5753 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5754 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5755 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5756 x_catch_errors (d);
5757 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5758 /* The ICCCM says this is
5759 the only valid choice. */
5760 RevertToParent,
5761 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5762 /* This is needed to detect the error
5763 if there is an error. */
5764 XSync (d, False);
5765 x_uncatch_errors ();
5767 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5768 #endif /* 0 */
5769 goto done;
5772 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5773 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5775 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5776 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5777 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5778 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5779 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5780 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5781 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5782 session manager and one for this. */
5783 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5784 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5785 #endif
5787 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5788 event.xclient.window);
5789 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5790 for a single Emacs process. */
5791 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5792 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5793 event.xclient.window,
5794 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5795 else if (f)
5796 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5797 event.xclient.window,
5798 0, 0);
5800 goto done;
5803 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5804 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5806 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5807 event.xclient.window);
5808 if (!f)
5809 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5811 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5812 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5813 goto done;
5816 goto done;
5819 if (event.xclient.message_type
5820 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5822 goto done;
5825 if (event.xclient.message_type
5826 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5828 int new_x, new_y;
5829 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5831 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5832 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5834 if (f)
5836 f->left_pos = new_x;
5837 f->top_pos = new_y;
5839 goto done;
5842 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5843 if (event.xclient.message_type
5844 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5846 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5847 if (f)
5848 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5849 &event, NULL);
5850 goto done;
5852 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5854 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5855 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5856 || (event.xclient.message_type
5857 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5859 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5860 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5861 currently never do because we are interested in
5862 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5863 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5864 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5865 if (!f)
5866 goto OTHER;
5867 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5868 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5869 goto done;
5872 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5873 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5874 we construct an input_event. */
5875 if (event.xclient.message_type
5876 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5878 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5879 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5880 goto done;
5882 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5884 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5885 if (event.xclient.message_type
5886 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
5888 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
5889 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
5890 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
5892 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5893 goto done;
5896 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
5898 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5899 if (!f)
5900 goto OTHER;
5901 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5902 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5904 break;
5906 case SelectionNotify:
5907 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
5908 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5909 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5910 goto OTHER;
5911 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5912 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5913 break;
5915 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5916 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
5917 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5918 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5919 goto OTHER;
5920 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5922 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5924 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5925 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5926 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5927 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5928 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5930 break;
5932 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5933 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
5934 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5935 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5936 goto OTHER;
5937 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5939 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5940 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5942 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5943 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5944 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5945 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5946 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5947 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5948 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5949 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5951 break;
5953 case PropertyNotify:
5954 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
5955 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
5956 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
5957 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
5959 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5960 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
5961 goto OTHER;
5963 case ReparentNotify:
5964 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5965 if (f)
5967 int x, y;
5968 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5969 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5970 f->left_pos = x;
5971 f->top_pos = y;
5973 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5974 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5975 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
5977 goto OTHER;
5979 case Expose:
5980 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5981 if (f)
5983 #ifdef USE_GTK
5984 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5985 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5986 event.xexpose.window,
5987 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5988 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5989 FALSE);
5990 #endif
5991 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5993 f->async_visible = 1;
5994 f->async_iconified = 0;
5995 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5996 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5998 else
5999 expose_frame (f,
6000 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6001 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6003 else
6005 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6006 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6007 #endif
6008 #if defined USE_LUCID
6009 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6010 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6011 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6013 Widget widget
6014 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6015 if (widget)
6016 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6018 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6020 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6021 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6022 goto OTHER;
6023 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6024 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6025 event.xexpose.window);
6027 if (bar)
6028 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6029 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6030 else
6031 goto OTHER;
6032 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6033 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6035 break;
6037 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6038 source area was obscured or not
6039 available. */
6040 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6041 if (f)
6043 expose_frame (f,
6044 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6045 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6046 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6048 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6049 else
6050 goto OTHER;
6051 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6052 break;
6054 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6055 source area was completely
6056 available. */
6057 break;
6059 case UnmapNotify:
6060 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6061 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6063 tip_window = 0;
6064 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6067 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6068 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6069 the frame was deleted. */
6071 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6072 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6073 display that won't ever be seen. */
6074 f->async_visible = 0;
6075 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6076 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6077 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6078 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6079 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6080 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6081 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6083 f->async_iconified = 1;
6085 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6086 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6089 goto OTHER;
6091 case MapNotify:
6092 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6093 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6094 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6095 goto OTHER;
6097 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6098 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6099 frame is visible. */
6100 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6101 if (f)
6103 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6104 the frame's display structures.
6105 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6106 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6107 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6108 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6109 if (! f->async_iconified)
6110 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6112 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6113 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6114 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6115 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6117 f->async_visible = 1;
6118 f->async_iconified = 0;
6119 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6121 if (f->iconified)
6123 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6124 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6126 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6127 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6128 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6129 to update the frame titles
6130 in case this is the second frame. */
6131 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6133 #ifdef USE_GTK
6134 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6135 #endif
6137 goto OTHER;
6139 case KeyPress:
6141 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6142 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6144 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6145 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6146 if (popup_activated ())
6147 goto OTHER;
6148 #endif
6150 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6152 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6153 mouse highlighting. */
6154 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6155 && (f == 0
6156 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6158 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6159 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6162 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6163 if (f == 0)
6165 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6166 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6167 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6168 event.xkey.window);
6169 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6171 widget = XtParent (widget);
6172 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6175 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6177 if (f != 0)
6179 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6180 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6181 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6182 his Emacs hang.
6184 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6185 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6186 status_return even if the input is too long to
6187 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6188 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6189 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6190 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6191 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6192 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6193 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6194 int modifiers;
6195 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6196 Lisp_Object c;
6198 #ifdef USE_GTK
6199 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6200 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6201 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6202 (see above). */
6203 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6204 #endif
6206 event.xkey.state
6207 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6208 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6209 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6211 /* This will have to go some day... */
6213 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6214 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6215 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6216 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6217 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6218 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6219 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6221 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6222 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6223 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6224 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6225 not it is combined with Meta. */
6226 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6227 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6229 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6230 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6232 Status status_return;
6234 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6235 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6236 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6237 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6238 &status_return);
6239 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6241 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6242 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6243 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6244 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6245 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6246 &status_return);
6248 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6249 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6250 break;
6251 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6253 keysym = NoSymbol;
6254 modifiers = 0;
6256 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6257 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6258 abort ();
6260 else
6261 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6262 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6263 &compose_status);
6264 #else
6265 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6266 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6267 &compose_status);
6268 #endif
6270 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6271 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6272 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6273 break;
6275 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6276 orig_keysym = keysym;
6278 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6279 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6280 inev.ie.modifiers
6281 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6282 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6284 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6285 translations to characters. */
6286 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6287 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6289 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6290 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6291 goto done_keysym;
6294 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6295 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6297 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6298 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6299 else
6300 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6301 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6302 goto done_keysym;
6305 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6306 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6307 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6308 Vx_keysym_table,
6309 Qnil))))
6311 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6312 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6313 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6314 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6315 goto done_keysym;
6318 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6319 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6320 || keysym == XK_Delete
6321 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6322 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6323 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6324 #endif
6325 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6326 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6327 #ifdef HPUX
6328 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6329 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6330 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6331 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6332 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6333 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6334 #endif
6335 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6336 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6337 #endif
6338 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6339 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6340 #endif
6341 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6342 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6343 #endif
6344 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6345 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6346 #endif
6347 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6348 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6349 #endif
6350 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6351 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6352 #endif
6353 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6354 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6355 #endif
6356 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6357 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6358 #endif
6359 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6360 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6361 #endif
6362 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6363 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6364 #endif
6365 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6366 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6367 #endif
6368 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6369 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6370 #endif
6371 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6372 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6373 #endif
6374 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6375 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6376 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6377 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6378 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6379 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6380 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6381 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6382 don't have real modifiers but
6383 should be treated similarly to
6384 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6385 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6386 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6387 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6388 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6389 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6390 #endif
6393 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6394 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6395 key. */
6396 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6397 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6398 goto done_keysym;
6401 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6402 register int i;
6403 register int c;
6404 int nchars, len;
6406 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6408 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6409 nchars++;
6410 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6413 if (nchars < nbytes)
6415 /* Decode the input data. */
6416 int require;
6417 unsigned char *p;
6419 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6420 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6421 we used just above and the locale. */
6422 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6423 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6424 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6425 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6426 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6427 gives us composition information. */
6428 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6430 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6431 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6432 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6433 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6434 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6435 nbytes = coding.produced;
6436 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6437 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6440 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6441 character events. */
6442 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6444 if (nchars == nbytes)
6445 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6446 else
6447 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6448 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6449 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6450 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6451 inev.ie.code = c;
6452 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6455 count += nchars;
6457 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6459 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6460 break;
6463 done_keysym:
6464 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6465 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6466 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6467 client. */
6468 break;
6469 #else
6470 goto OTHER;
6471 #endif
6473 case KeyRelease:
6474 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6475 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6476 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6477 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6478 client. */
6479 break;
6480 #else
6481 goto OTHER;
6482 #endif
6484 case EnterNotify:
6485 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6486 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6488 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6490 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6491 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6493 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6494 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6495 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6496 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6497 #ifdef USE_GTK
6498 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6499 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6500 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6501 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6502 #endif
6503 goto OTHER;
6505 case FocusIn:
6506 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6507 goto OTHER;
6509 case LeaveNotify:
6510 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6511 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6513 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6514 if (f)
6516 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6518 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6519 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6520 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6521 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6524 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6525 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6526 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6527 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6528 if (any_help_event_p)
6529 do_help = -1;
6531 #ifdef USE_GTK
6532 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6533 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6534 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6535 #endif
6536 goto OTHER;
6538 case FocusOut:
6539 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6540 goto OTHER;
6542 case MotionNotify:
6544 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6545 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6546 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6548 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6549 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6550 f = last_mouse_frame;
6551 else
6552 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6554 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6556 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6557 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6560 #ifdef USE_GTK
6561 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6562 f = 0;
6563 #endif
6564 if (f)
6567 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6568 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6569 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6571 Lisp_Object window;
6573 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6574 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6575 0, 0, 0, 0);
6577 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6578 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6579 will be selected only when it is active. */
6580 if (WINDOWP (window)
6581 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6582 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6583 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6584 create event iff we don't leave the
6585 selected frame. */
6586 && (focus_follows_mouse
6587 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6588 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6590 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6591 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6594 last_window=window;
6596 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6597 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6599 else
6601 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6602 struct scroll_bar *bar
6603 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6604 event.xmotion.window);
6606 if (bar)
6607 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6608 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6610 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6611 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6612 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6615 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6616 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6617 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6618 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6619 do_help = 1;
6620 goto OTHER;
6623 case ConfigureNotify:
6624 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6625 #ifdef USE_GTK
6626 if (!f
6627 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6628 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6630 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6631 event.xconfigure.height);
6632 f = 0;
6634 #endif
6635 if (f)
6637 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6638 #ifndef USE_GTK
6639 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6640 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6642 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6643 is called by the code that handles resizing
6644 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6646 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6647 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6648 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6649 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6650 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6651 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6652 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6654 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6655 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6656 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6659 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6660 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6661 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6662 #endif
6664 #ifdef USE_GTK
6665 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6666 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6667 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6668 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6669 #endif
6671 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6674 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6675 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6676 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6677 #endif
6680 goto OTHER;
6682 case ButtonRelease:
6683 case ButtonPress:
6685 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6686 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6687 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6689 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6690 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6691 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6693 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6694 && last_mouse_frame
6695 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6696 f = last_mouse_frame;
6697 else
6698 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6700 #ifdef USE_GTK
6701 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6702 f = 0;
6703 #endif
6704 if (f)
6706 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6707 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6708 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6710 Lisp_Object window;
6711 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6712 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6714 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6715 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6717 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6719 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6720 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6721 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6722 event.xbutton.state));
6726 if (!tool_bar_p)
6727 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6728 if (! popup_activated ())
6729 #endif
6731 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6733 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6734 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6736 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6737 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6739 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6740 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6742 else
6743 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6745 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6746 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6747 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6749 else
6751 struct scroll_bar *bar
6752 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6753 event.xbutton.window);
6755 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6756 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6757 scroll bars. */
6758 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6760 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6761 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6763 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6764 if (bar)
6765 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6766 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6769 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6771 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6772 last_mouse_frame = f;
6774 if (!tool_bar_p)
6775 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6777 else
6778 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6780 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6781 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6782 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6783 if (f != 0)
6784 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6786 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6787 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6788 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6789 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6790 Instead, save it away
6791 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6792 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6793 if (! popup_activated ()
6794 #ifdef USE_GTK
6795 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6796 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6797 #endif
6798 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6799 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6800 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6801 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6802 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6803 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6804 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6805 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6807 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6808 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6809 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6811 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6813 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6814 goto OTHER;
6816 else
6817 goto OTHER;
6818 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6820 break;
6822 case CirculateNotify:
6823 goto OTHER;
6825 case CirculateRequest:
6826 goto OTHER;
6828 case VisibilityNotify:
6829 goto OTHER;
6831 case MappingNotify:
6832 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6833 local cache. */
6834 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6836 case MappingModifier:
6837 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6838 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6839 case MappingKeyboard:
6840 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6842 goto OTHER;
6844 case DestroyNotify:
6845 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6846 break;
6848 default:
6849 OTHER:
6850 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6851 BLOCK_INPUT;
6852 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6853 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6854 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6855 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6856 break;
6859 done:
6860 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6862 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6863 count++;
6866 if (do_help
6867 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6869 Lisp_Object frame;
6871 if (f)
6872 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6873 else
6874 frame = Qnil;
6876 if (do_help > 0)
6878 any_help_event_p = 1;
6879 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6880 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6882 else
6884 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6885 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6887 count++;
6890 *eventp = event;
6891 return count;
6895 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6896 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6897 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6899 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6901 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
6903 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6904 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6906 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6908 if (dpyinfo)
6909 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6911 return finish;
6915 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6916 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6917 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6919 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6920 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
6921 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
6922 C chars).
6924 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6926 static int
6927 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
6929 int count = 0;
6930 XEvent event;
6931 int event_found = 0;
6933 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6935 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6936 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
6937 pending_signals = 1;
6938 #endif
6939 return -1;
6942 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6943 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
6944 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
6945 #endif
6946 BLOCK_INPUT;
6948 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6949 input_signal_count++;
6951 ++handling_signal;
6953 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
6954 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
6955 if (terminal->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
6957 struct input_event inev;
6958 BLOCK_INPUT;
6959 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
6960 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
6961 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
6963 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6964 count++;
6966 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6968 #endif
6970 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
6971 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
6973 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
6974 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
6977 #ifndef USE_GTK
6978 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
6980 int finish;
6982 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
6984 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6985 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
6986 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
6987 continue;
6988 #endif
6989 event_found = 1;
6991 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
6992 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
6994 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
6995 goto out;
6998 #else /* USE_GTK */
7000 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7001 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7002 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7003 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7005 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7006 from all displays. */
7008 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7010 current_count = count;
7011 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7013 gtk_main_iteration ();
7015 count = current_count;
7016 current_count = -1;
7017 current_hold_quit = 0;
7019 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7020 break;
7022 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7024 out:;
7026 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7027 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7028 if (! event_found)
7030 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7031 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7032 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7033 x_noop_count++;
7034 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7036 x_noop_count=0;
7038 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7039 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7041 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7043 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7044 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7048 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7049 raise it now. */
7050 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7051 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7053 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7054 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7057 --handling_signal;
7058 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7060 return count;
7066 /***********************************************************************
7067 Text Cursor
7068 ***********************************************************************/
7070 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7071 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7073 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7074 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7075 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7077 static void
7078 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7080 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7081 XRectangle clip_rect;
7082 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7084 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7086 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7087 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7088 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7089 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7090 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7092 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7096 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7098 static void
7099 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7101 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7102 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7103 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7104 int x, y, wd, h;
7105 XGCValues xgcv;
7106 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7107 GC gc;
7109 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7110 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7111 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7112 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7113 return;
7115 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7116 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7117 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7119 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7120 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7121 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7122 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7123 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7124 else
7125 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7126 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7127 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7129 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7130 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7131 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7132 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7136 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7138 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7139 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7140 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7141 --gerd. */
7143 static void
7144 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7146 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7147 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7149 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7150 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7151 and mini-buffer. */
7152 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7153 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7154 return;
7156 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7157 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7158 the bar might not be in the window. */
7159 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7161 struct glyph_row *row;
7162 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7163 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7165 else
7167 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7168 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7169 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7170 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7171 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7172 XGCValues xgcv;
7174 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7175 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7176 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7177 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7178 that the glyph is legible. */
7179 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7180 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7181 else
7182 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7183 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7185 if (gc)
7186 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7187 else
7189 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7190 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7193 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7195 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7197 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7199 if (width < 0)
7200 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7201 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7203 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7205 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7206 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7207 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7208 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7210 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7211 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7212 width, row->height);
7214 else
7216 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7218 if (width < 0)
7219 width = row->height;
7221 width = min (row->height, width);
7223 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7224 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7226 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7227 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7228 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7229 row->height - width),
7230 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7233 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7238 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7240 static void
7241 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7243 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7244 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7245 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7246 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7250 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7252 static void
7253 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7255 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7256 x, y, width, height, False);
7257 #ifdef USE_GTK
7258 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7259 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7260 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7261 #endif
7265 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7267 static void
7268 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7270 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7272 if (on_p)
7274 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7275 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7277 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7278 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7279 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7280 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7282 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7283 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7285 else
7287 switch (cursor_type)
7289 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7290 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7291 break;
7293 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7294 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7295 break;
7297 case BAR_CURSOR:
7298 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7299 break;
7301 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7302 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7303 break;
7305 case NO_CURSOR:
7306 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7307 break;
7309 default:
7310 abort ();
7314 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7315 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7316 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7317 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7318 #endif
7321 #ifndef XFlush
7322 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7323 #endif
7327 /* Icons. */
7329 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7332 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7334 int bitmap_id;
7336 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7337 return 1;
7339 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7340 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7341 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7342 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7344 if (STRINGP (file))
7346 #ifdef USE_GTK
7347 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7348 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7349 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7350 return 0;
7351 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7352 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7353 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7355 else
7357 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7358 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7360 int rc = -1;
7362 #ifdef USE_GTK
7364 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7365 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7366 return 0;
7368 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7370 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7371 if (rc != -1)
7372 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7374 #endif
7376 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7377 if (rc == -1)
7379 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7380 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7381 if (rc == -1)
7382 return 1;
7384 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7385 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7389 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7390 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7391 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7392 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7393 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7395 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7398 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7399 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7401 return 0;
7405 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7406 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7409 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7411 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7412 return 1;
7415 XTextProperty text;
7416 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7417 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7418 text.format = 8;
7419 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7420 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7423 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7424 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7425 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7426 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7428 return 0;
7431 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7433 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7434 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7436 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7437 be called from a signal handler.
7440 struct x_error_message_stack {
7441 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7442 Display *dpy;
7443 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7445 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7447 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7448 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7449 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7451 static void
7452 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7454 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7455 x_error_message->string,
7456 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7459 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7460 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7461 operating on.
7463 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7464 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7465 stored in *x_error_message.
7467 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7468 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7470 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7472 void x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format);
7474 void
7475 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7477 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7479 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7480 XSync (dpy, False);
7482 data->dpy = dpy;
7483 data->string[0] = 0;
7484 data->prev = x_error_message;
7485 x_error_message = data;
7488 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7489 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7491 void
7492 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7494 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7496 BLOCK_INPUT;
7498 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7499 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7500 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7501 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7503 tmp = x_error_message;
7504 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7505 xfree (tmp);
7506 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7509 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7510 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7511 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7513 void
7514 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7516 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7517 XSync (dpy, False);
7519 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7521 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7522 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7523 x_uncatch_errors ();
7524 error (format, string);
7528 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7529 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7532 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7534 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7535 XSync (dpy, False);
7537 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7540 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7542 void
7543 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7545 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7548 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7549 * idea. --lorentey */
7550 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7552 void
7553 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7555 while (x_error_message)
7556 x_uncatch_errors ();
7558 #endif
7560 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7563 x_catching_errors (void)
7565 return x_error_message != 0;
7568 #if 0
7569 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7570 x_trace_wire (void)
7572 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7574 #endif /* ! 0 */
7577 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7578 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7579 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7580 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7581 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7583 static SIGTYPE
7584 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7585 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7587 #ifdef USG
7588 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7589 must reestablish each time */
7590 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7591 #endif /* USG */
7595 /************************************************************************
7596 Handling X errors
7597 ************************************************************************/
7599 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7601 static char *error_msg;
7603 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7604 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7605 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7607 static void
7608 x_fatal_error_signal (void)
7610 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7611 exit (70);
7614 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7615 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7617 static SIGTYPE
7618 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7620 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7621 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7622 int index = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7624 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7625 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7626 handling_signal = 0;
7628 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7629 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7630 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7631 the original message here. */
7632 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7634 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7635 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7637 if (dpyinfo)
7639 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7640 frame on it. */
7641 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7642 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7645 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7646 that are on the dead display. */
7647 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7649 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7650 minibuf_frame
7651 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7652 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7653 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7654 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7655 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7656 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7659 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7660 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7661 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7662 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7663 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7664 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7666 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7667 trying to find a replacement. */
7668 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7669 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7672 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7673 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7674 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7676 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7677 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7678 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7680 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7681 in the first call to make-frame-on-display.
7683 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7684 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7685 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
7687 if (dpyinfo)
7689 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7690 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7691 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7693 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7694 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7695 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7697 #endif
7699 #ifdef USE_GTK
7700 /* Due to bugs in some Gtk+ versions, just exit here if this
7701 is the last display/terminal. */
7702 if (terminal_list->next_terminal == NULL)
7704 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7705 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7706 /* NOTREACHED */
7708 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7709 #endif
7711 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7712 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7714 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7715 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7716 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7717 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7718 abort ();
7721 Lisp_Object tmp;
7722 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7723 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7727 x_uncatch_errors ();
7729 if (terminal_list == 0)
7731 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7732 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7733 /* NOTREACHED */
7736 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7737 #ifdef SIGIO
7738 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7739 #endif
7740 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7741 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7743 unbind_to (index, Qnil);
7744 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7745 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7746 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7747 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7748 error ("%s", error_msg);
7751 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7752 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7753 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7755 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7756 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7758 static int
7759 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7761 if (x_error_message)
7762 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7763 else
7764 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7765 return 0;
7768 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7769 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7770 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7772 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7774 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7775 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7777 static void NO_INLINE
7778 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7780 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7782 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7783 or colors that are not defined. */
7785 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7786 return;
7788 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7789 original error handler. */
7791 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7792 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7793 buf, error->request_code);
7794 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7798 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7799 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7800 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7802 static int
7803 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7805 char buf[256];
7807 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7808 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7809 return 0;
7812 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7814 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7815 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7816 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7817 FONT-OBJECT. */
7819 Lisp_Object
7820 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7822 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7824 if (fontset < 0)
7825 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7826 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7827 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7828 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7829 do. */
7830 return font_object;
7832 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7833 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7834 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7835 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7836 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7838 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7840 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7841 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7843 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7844 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7845 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7847 else
7849 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7850 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7853 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7855 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7856 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7857 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7858 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7859 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7862 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7863 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7864 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7866 BLOCK_INPUT;
7867 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7868 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7870 #endif
7872 return font_object;
7876 /***********************************************************************
7877 X Input Methods
7878 ***********************************************************************/
7880 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7882 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7884 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7885 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7886 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7888 static void
7889 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7891 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7892 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7894 BLOCK_INPUT;
7896 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7897 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7899 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7900 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7902 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7903 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7907 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7908 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7909 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7910 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7913 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7915 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7916 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7917 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7918 #endif
7920 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7921 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7923 static void
7924 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7926 XIM xim;
7928 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7929 if (use_xim)
7931 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7932 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
7933 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7934 emacs_class);
7935 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7937 if (xim)
7939 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7940 XIMCallback destroy;
7941 #endif
7943 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7944 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7946 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7947 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7948 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7949 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7950 #endif
7954 else
7955 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
7956 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7960 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
7962 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
7963 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
7964 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
7965 when the callback was registered. */
7967 static void
7968 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7970 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
7971 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
7973 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
7974 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7975 return;
7977 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
7979 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
7980 as they have no XIC. */
7981 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
7983 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
7985 BLOCK_INPUT;
7986 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7988 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7990 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
7991 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
7992 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
7994 create_frame_xic (f);
7995 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
7996 xic_set_statusarea (f);
7997 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
7999 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8000 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8005 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8009 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8012 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8013 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8014 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8015 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8017 static void
8018 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8020 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8021 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8022 if (use_xim)
8024 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8025 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8026 int len;
8028 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8029 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8030 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8031 len = strlen (resource_name);
8032 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8033 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8034 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8035 resource_name, emacs_class,
8036 xim_instantiate_callback,
8037 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8038 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8039 least, hence the configure test. */
8040 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8041 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8042 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8043 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8045 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8049 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8051 static void
8052 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8054 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8055 if (use_xim)
8057 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8058 if (dpyinfo->display)
8059 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8060 NULL, emacs_class,
8061 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8062 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8063 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8064 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8065 if (dpyinfo->display)
8066 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8067 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8068 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8070 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8073 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8077 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8078 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8080 void
8081 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8083 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8085 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8086 is already for the top-left corner. */
8087 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8088 return;
8090 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8091 position that fits on the screen. */
8092 if (flags & XNegative)
8093 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8094 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8097 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8099 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8100 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8101 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8103 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8104 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8105 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8106 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8107 is right, though.
8109 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8110 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8112 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8113 #endif
8115 if (flags & YNegative)
8116 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8117 - height + f->top_pos;
8120 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8121 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8122 so the flags should correspond. */
8123 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8126 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8127 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8128 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8129 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8130 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8132 void
8133 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8135 int modified_top, modified_left;
8137 if (change_gravity > 0)
8139 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8140 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8142 f->top_pos = yoff;
8143 f->left_pos = xoff;
8144 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8145 if (xoff < 0)
8146 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8147 if (yoff < 0)
8148 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8149 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8151 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8153 BLOCK_INPUT;
8154 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8156 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8157 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8159 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8161 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8162 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8163 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8164 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8165 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8168 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8169 modified_left, modified_top);
8171 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8172 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8173 ? 1 : 0);
8175 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8176 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8177 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8178 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8179 of the frame.
8181 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8182 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8183 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8185 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8186 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8187 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8188 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8189 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8190 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8192 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8195 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8196 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8197 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8198 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8199 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8201 static int
8202 wm_supports (struct frame *f, const char *atomname)
8204 Atom actual_type;
8205 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8206 int i, rc, actual_format;
8207 Atom prop_atom;
8208 Window wmcheck_window;
8209 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8210 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8211 long max_len = 65536;
8212 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8213 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8214 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8215 Atom want_atom;
8217 BLOCK_INPUT;
8219 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", False);
8221 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8222 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8223 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8224 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8225 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8227 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8229 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8230 x_uncatch_errors ();
8231 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8232 return 0;
8235 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8236 XFree (tmp_data);
8238 /* Check if window exists. */
8239 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8240 x_sync (f);
8241 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8243 x_uncatch_errors ();
8244 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8245 return 0;
8248 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8250 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8251 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8252 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8253 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8254 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8255 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8257 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8258 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTED", False);
8259 tmp_data = NULL;
8260 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8261 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8262 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8263 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8265 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8267 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8268 x_uncatch_errors ();
8269 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8270 return 0;
8273 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8274 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8275 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8278 rc = 0;
8279 want_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, atomname, False);
8281 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8282 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8284 x_uncatch_errors ();
8285 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8287 return rc;
8290 static void
8291 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, const char *what, const char *what2)
8293 const char *atom = "_NET_WM_STATE";
8294 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8295 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8296 make_number (32),
8297 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8298 Fcons
8299 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8300 Fcons
8301 (make_unibyte_string (what, strlen (what)),
8302 what2 != 0
8303 ? Fcons (make_unibyte_string (what2, strlen (what2)),
8304 Qnil)
8305 : Qnil)));
8308 void
8309 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8311 Lisp_Object frame;
8313 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8314 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8315 "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", NULL);
8318 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8319 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8320 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8322 static void
8323 get_current_vm_state (struct frame *f,
8324 Window window,
8325 int *size_state,
8326 int *sticky)
8328 Atom actual_type;
8329 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8330 int i, rc, actual_format;
8331 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8332 long max_len = 65536;
8333 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8334 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8335 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8337 *sticky = 0;
8338 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8340 BLOCK_INPUT;
8341 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8342 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8343 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8344 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8345 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8347 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8349 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8350 x_uncatch_errors ();
8351 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8352 return;
8355 x_uncatch_errors ();
8357 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8359 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8360 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8362 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8363 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8364 else
8365 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8367 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8369 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8370 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8371 else
8372 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8374 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen_atom)
8375 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8376 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8377 *sticky = 1;
8380 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8381 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8384 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8386 static int
8387 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8389 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE");
8390 Lisp_Object lval = get_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen);
8391 int cur, dummy;
8393 get_current_vm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8395 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8396 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8397 if (!have_net_atom)
8398 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN");
8400 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8402 Lisp_Object frame;
8403 const char *fs = "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8404 const char *fw = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8405 const char *fh = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8407 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8409 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8410 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8411 are sent at once. */
8412 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8414 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8415 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8416 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8417 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fw, fh);
8418 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fs, NULL);
8419 break;
8420 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8421 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8422 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8423 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fs, fh);
8424 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8425 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fw, NULL);
8426 break;
8427 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8428 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8429 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8430 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fs, fw);
8431 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8432 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fh, NULL);
8433 break;
8434 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8435 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8436 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fs, NULL);
8437 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fw, fh);
8438 break;
8439 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8440 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8441 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fs, NULL);
8442 else
8443 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fw, fh);
8446 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8450 return have_net_atom;
8453 static void
8454 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8456 if (f->async_visible)
8458 BLOCK_INPUT;
8459 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8460 x_sync (f);
8461 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8466 static void
8467 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8469 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8470 Lisp_Object lval;
8471 int sticky = 0;
8473 get_current_vm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8474 lval = Qnil;
8475 switch (value)
8477 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8478 lval = Qfullwidth;
8479 break;
8480 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8481 lval = Qfullheight;
8482 break;
8483 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8484 lval = Qfullboth;
8485 break;
8486 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8487 lval = Qmaximized;
8488 break;
8491 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8492 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8495 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8496 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8497 static void
8498 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8500 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8501 return;
8503 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8504 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8506 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8508 int width = FRAME_COLS (f), height = FRAME_LINES (f);
8509 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8511 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8513 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8514 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8515 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8516 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8517 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8518 break;
8519 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8520 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8521 break;
8522 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8523 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8526 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8528 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8529 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8530 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8535 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8536 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8537 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8538 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8539 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8540 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8541 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8543 static void
8544 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8546 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8548 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8549 window manager window around the frame. */
8551 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8553 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8555 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8557 int adjusted_left;
8558 int adjusted_top;
8560 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8561 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8562 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8564 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8566 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8567 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8569 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8570 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8572 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8574 else
8575 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8576 frame's position. */
8578 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8582 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8583 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8584 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8585 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8586 of an exact comparison. */
8588 static void
8589 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8591 int count = 0;
8593 while (count++ < 50)
8595 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8597 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8598 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8599 loop. */
8601 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8602 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8604 if (fuzzy)
8606 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8607 pixels. */
8609 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8610 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8611 return;
8613 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8614 return;
8617 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8618 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8620 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8624 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8625 void
8626 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8628 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8630 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8631 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8632 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8634 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8635 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8637 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8638 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8639 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8640 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8641 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8643 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8645 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8646 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8647 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8648 BLOCK_INPUT;
8649 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8651 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8652 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8654 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8655 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8657 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8658 break; /* Timeout */
8660 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8661 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8665 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8666 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8667 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8668 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8670 static void
8671 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8673 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8675 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8676 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8677 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8679 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8681 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8683 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8684 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8685 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8686 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8688 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8689 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8690 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8691 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8694 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8695 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8696 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8697 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8698 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8700 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8701 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8702 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8703 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8705 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8706 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8707 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8708 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8709 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8711 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8712 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8714 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8715 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8716 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8717 if (f->async_visible)
8718 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8719 else
8721 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8722 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8723 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8724 x_sync (f);
8729 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8730 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8731 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8732 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8734 void
8735 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8737 BLOCK_INPUT;
8739 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8741 int r, c;
8743 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8744 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8745 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8746 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8747 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8748 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8749 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8750 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8751 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8752 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8753 is however. */
8754 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8755 #endif
8756 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8757 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8758 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8759 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8760 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8761 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8762 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8765 #ifdef USE_GTK
8766 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8767 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8768 else
8769 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8770 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8772 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8774 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8776 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8777 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8779 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8780 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8781 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8782 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8783 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8785 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8788 /* Mouse warping. */
8790 void
8791 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8793 int pix_x, pix_y;
8795 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8796 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8798 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8799 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8801 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8802 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8804 BLOCK_INPUT;
8806 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8807 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8808 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8811 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8813 void
8814 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8816 BLOCK_INPUT;
8818 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8819 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8820 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8823 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8825 void
8826 x_focus_on_frame (struct frame *f)
8828 #if 0
8829 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8830 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8831 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8832 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8833 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8834 #endif /* ! 0 */
8837 void
8838 x_unfocus_frame (struct frame *f)
8840 #if 0
8841 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8842 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8843 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8844 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8845 #endif /* ! 0 */
8848 /* Raise frame F. */
8850 void
8851 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8853 BLOCK_INPUT;
8854 if (f->async_visible)
8855 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8857 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8858 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8861 /* Lower frame F. */
8863 void
8864 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8866 if (f->async_visible)
8868 BLOCK_INPUT;
8869 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8870 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8871 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8875 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8877 void
8878 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8880 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8881 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8883 const char *atom = "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW";
8884 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, atom))
8886 Lisp_Object frame;
8887 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8888 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8889 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8890 make_number (32),
8891 Fcons (make_number (1),
8892 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8893 Qnil)));
8897 static void
8898 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8900 if (raise_flag)
8901 x_raise_frame (f);
8902 else
8903 x_lower_frame (f);
8906 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8908 void
8909 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8911 Atom atom;
8912 unsigned long data[2];
8914 atom = XInternAtom (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), "_XEMBED_INFO", False);
8916 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8917 data[1] = flags;
8919 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), atom, atom,
8920 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8923 void
8924 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time, enum xembed_message message, long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8926 XEvent event;
8928 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8929 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
8930 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
8931 event.xclient.format = 32;
8932 event.xclient.data.l[0] = time;
8933 event.xclient.data.l[1] = message;
8934 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
8935 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
8936 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
8938 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
8939 False, NoEventMask, &event);
8940 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8943 /* Change of visibility. */
8945 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8946 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8947 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8948 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8949 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8950 finishes with it. */
8952 void
8953 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
8955 Lisp_Object type;
8956 int original_top, original_left;
8957 int retry_count = 2;
8959 retry:
8961 BLOCK_INPUT;
8963 type = x_icon_type (f);
8964 if (!NILP (type))
8965 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8967 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8969 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8970 call x_set_offset a second time
8971 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8972 before the window gets really visible. */
8973 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8974 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
8975 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8976 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8978 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8980 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8981 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8982 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8983 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
8984 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
8985 else
8987 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8988 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8990 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8991 #ifdef USE_GTK
8992 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8993 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8994 #else
8995 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
8996 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
8997 else
8998 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8999 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9000 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9003 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9005 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9006 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9007 so that incoming events are handled. */
9009 Lisp_Object frame;
9010 int count;
9011 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9012 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9013 will set it when they are handled. */
9014 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9016 original_left = f->left_pos;
9017 original_top = f->top_pos;
9019 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9020 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9022 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9024 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9025 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9026 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9027 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9029 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9030 because the window manager may choose the position
9031 and we don't want to override it. */
9033 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9034 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9035 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9036 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9037 && previously_visible)
9039 Drawable rootw;
9040 int x, y;
9041 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9043 BLOCK_INPUT;
9045 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9046 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9047 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9048 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9049 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9050 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9051 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9052 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9053 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9055 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9056 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9057 original_left, original_top);
9059 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9062 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9064 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9065 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9066 MapNotify at all.. */
9067 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9068 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9070 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9071 x_sync (f);
9073 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9074 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9075 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9076 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9077 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9078 probably a bug. */
9079 if (input_polling_used ())
9081 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9082 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9083 handler reset it. */
9084 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9085 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9086 poll_for_input_1 ();
9087 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9090 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9091 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9094 /* 2000-09-28: In
9096 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9097 (iconify-frame f)
9098 (raise-frame f))
9100 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9101 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9102 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9103 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9105 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9106 goto retry;
9110 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9112 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9114 void
9115 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9117 Window window;
9119 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9120 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9122 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9123 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9124 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9126 BLOCK_INPUT;
9128 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9129 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9130 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9131 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9132 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9133 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9135 #ifdef USE_GTK
9136 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9137 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9138 else
9139 #else
9140 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9141 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9142 else
9143 #endif
9146 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9147 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9149 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9150 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9154 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9155 just by the event that we get from the server.
9156 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9157 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9158 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9159 f->visible = 0;
9160 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9161 f->async_visible = 0;
9162 f->async_iconified = 0;
9164 x_sync (f);
9166 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9169 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9171 void
9172 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9174 int result;
9175 Lisp_Object type;
9177 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9178 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9179 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9181 if (f->async_iconified)
9182 return;
9184 BLOCK_INPUT;
9186 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9188 type = x_icon_type (f);
9189 if (!NILP (type))
9190 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9192 #ifdef USE_GTK
9193 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9195 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9196 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9198 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9199 f->iconified = 1;
9200 f->visible = 1;
9201 f->async_iconified = 1;
9202 f->async_visible = 0;
9203 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9204 return;
9206 #endif
9208 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9210 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9212 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9213 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9214 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9215 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9216 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9217 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9218 so we have to record it here. */
9219 f->iconified = 1;
9220 f->visible = 1;
9221 f->async_iconified = 1;
9222 f->async_visible = 0;
9223 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9224 return;
9227 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9228 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9229 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9230 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9232 if (!result)
9233 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9235 f->async_iconified = 1;
9236 f->async_visible = 0;
9239 BLOCK_INPUT;
9240 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9241 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9242 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9244 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9245 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9246 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9247 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9248 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9249 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9251 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9252 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9254 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9255 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9257 XEvent message;
9259 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9260 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9261 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9262 message.xclient.format = 32;
9263 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9265 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9266 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9267 False,
9268 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9269 &message))
9271 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9272 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9276 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9277 IconicState. */
9278 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9280 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9282 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9283 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9286 f->async_iconified = 1;
9287 f->async_visible = 0;
9289 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9290 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9291 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9295 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9297 void
9298 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9300 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9301 Lisp_Object bar;
9302 struct scroll_bar *b;
9304 BLOCK_INPUT;
9306 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9307 commands to the X server. */
9308 if (dpyinfo->display)
9310 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9311 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9312 face. */
9313 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9314 free_frame_faces (f);
9316 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9317 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9319 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9320 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9321 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9322 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9323 toolkit scroll bars. */
9324 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9326 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9327 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9329 #endif
9331 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9332 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9333 free_frame_xic (f);
9334 #endif
9336 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9337 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9339 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9340 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9342 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9343 we are using a toolkit. */
9344 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9345 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9347 free_frame_menubar (f);
9348 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9350 #ifdef USE_GTK
9351 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9352 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9354 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9355 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9356 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9358 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9359 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9360 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9361 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9362 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9363 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9365 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9366 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9367 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9368 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9369 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9370 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9371 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9372 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9373 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9374 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9375 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9376 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9377 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9378 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9379 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9381 x_free_gcs (f);
9382 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9385 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9386 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9387 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9389 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9390 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9391 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9392 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9393 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9394 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9396 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9398 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9399 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9400 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9401 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9402 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9403 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9404 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9407 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9411 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9413 void
9414 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9416 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9418 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9419 commands to the X server. */
9420 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9421 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9423 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9427 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9429 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9430 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9431 that the window now has.
9432 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9433 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9434 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9436 #ifndef USE_GTK
9437 void
9438 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9440 XSizeHints size_hints;
9441 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9443 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9444 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9446 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9447 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9449 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9450 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9452 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9453 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9454 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9455 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9456 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9457 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9459 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9461 int base_width, base_height;
9462 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9464 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9465 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9467 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9469 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9470 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9471 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9472 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9473 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9475 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9476 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9477 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9479 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9480 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9481 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9482 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9483 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9486 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9487 if (flags)
9489 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9490 goto no_read;
9494 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9495 long supplied_return;
9496 int value;
9498 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9499 &supplied_return);
9501 if (flags)
9502 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9503 else
9505 if (value == 0)
9506 hints.flags = 0;
9507 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9508 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9509 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9510 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9511 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9512 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9513 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9514 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9518 no_read:
9520 #ifdef PWinGravity
9521 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9522 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9524 if (user_position)
9526 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9527 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9529 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9531 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9533 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9535 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9537 void
9538 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9540 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9541 Arg al[1];
9543 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9544 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9545 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9546 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9548 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9549 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9551 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9552 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9555 void
9556 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, int pixmap_id)
9558 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9560 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9561 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9562 #endif
9564 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9566 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9567 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9568 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9569 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9571 else
9573 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9574 pixmap. */
9575 return;
9579 #ifdef USE_GTK
9581 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9582 return;
9585 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9588 Arg al[1];
9589 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9590 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9591 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9592 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9595 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9597 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9598 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9600 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9603 void
9604 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9606 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9608 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9609 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9610 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9612 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9616 /***********************************************************************
9617 Fonts
9618 ***********************************************************************/
9620 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9622 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9623 font table. */
9625 static void
9626 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9628 Lisp_Object frame;
9630 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9631 if (font->driver->check)
9632 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9635 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9638 /***********************************************************************
9639 Initialization
9640 ***********************************************************************/
9642 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9643 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9644 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9645 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9647 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9648 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9649 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9651 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9652 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9653 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9654 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9655 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9656 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9657 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9660 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9662 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9664 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9666 static int x_initialized;
9668 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
9669 static int x_session_initialized;
9670 #endif
9672 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9673 the screen number from the server number. */
9674 static int
9675 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9677 int seen_colon = 0;
9678 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
9679 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9680 int length_until_period = 0;
9682 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9683 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9684 length_until_period++;
9686 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9687 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9688 name1 += 4;
9689 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9690 name2 += 4;
9691 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9692 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9693 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9694 name1 += system_name_length;
9695 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9696 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9697 name2 += system_name_length;
9698 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9699 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9700 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9701 name1 += length_until_period;
9702 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9703 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9704 name2 += length_until_period;
9706 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9708 if (*name1 == ':')
9709 seen_colon++;
9710 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9711 return 1;
9713 return (seen_colon
9714 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9715 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9718 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9719 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9720 to 5. */
9721 static void
9722 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9724 int nr = 0;
9725 int off = 0;
9727 while (!(mask & 1))
9729 off++;
9730 mask >>= 1;
9733 while (mask & 1)
9735 nr++;
9736 mask >>= 1;
9739 *offset = off;
9740 *bits = nr;
9743 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9744 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9747 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9749 int dpy_ok = 1;
9750 Display *dpy;
9752 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9753 if (dpy)
9754 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9755 else
9756 dpy_ok = 0;
9757 return dpy_ok;
9760 #ifdef USE_GTK
9761 static void
9762 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level, const gchar *message, gpointer user_data)
9764 if (!strstr (message, "g_set_prgname"))
9765 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, message);
9767 #endif
9769 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9770 the structure that describes the open display.
9771 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9773 struct x_display_info *
9774 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9776 int connection;
9777 Display *dpy;
9778 struct terminal *terminal;
9779 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9780 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9782 BLOCK_INPUT;
9784 if (!x_initialized)
9786 x_initialize ();
9787 ++x_initialized;
9790 if (! x_display_ok (SDATA (display_name)))
9791 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name));
9793 #ifdef USE_GTK
9795 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9796 int argc;
9797 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9798 char **argv2 = argv;
9799 guint id;
9801 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9803 xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9805 else
9807 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9808 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9810 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9811 argv[argc] = 0;
9813 argc = 0;
9814 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9816 if (! NILP (display_name))
9818 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9819 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
9822 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9823 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9825 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9827 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9828 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9829 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9830 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9831 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9832 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9834 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9835 fixup_locale ();
9836 xg_initialize ();
9838 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
9840 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9841 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9843 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9845 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9846 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9848 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9849 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9851 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9852 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
9855 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9856 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9859 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9860 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9861 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9862 errors with X11R5:
9863 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9864 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9865 So let's not use it until R6. */
9866 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9867 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9868 #endif
9871 int argc = 0;
9872 char *argv[3];
9874 argv[0] = "";
9875 argc = 1;
9876 if (xrm_option)
9878 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9879 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9881 turn_on_atimers (0);
9882 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
9883 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9884 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9885 &argc, argv);
9886 turn_on_atimers (1);
9888 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9889 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9890 fixup_locale ();
9891 #endif
9894 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9895 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9896 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
9897 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9898 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9900 /* Detect failure. */
9901 if (dpy == 0)
9903 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9904 return 0;
9907 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9909 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
9910 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
9912 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
9915 struct x_display_info *share;
9916 Lisp_Object tail;
9918 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
9919 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
9920 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
9921 SDATA (display_name)))
9922 break;
9923 if (share)
9924 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
9925 else
9927 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
9928 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
9929 terminal->kboard->Vwindow_system = Qx;
9931 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
9932 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
9933 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
9934 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
9935 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
9937 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
9939 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
9941 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
9942 list of terminals. */
9943 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9944 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
9945 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
9946 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
9948 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
9949 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
9950 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9951 terminal->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
9952 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
9953 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
9954 BLOCK_INPUT;
9955 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
9956 terminal_list = terminal;
9957 UNGCPRO;
9960 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
9961 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
9962 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
9963 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
9964 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
9966 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
9969 /* Put this display on the chain. */
9970 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
9971 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
9973 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
9974 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
9975 x_display_name_list);
9976 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
9978 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
9980 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
9981 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
9982 strncpy (terminal->name, SDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
9983 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
9985 #if 0
9986 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
9987 #endif /* ! 0 */
9989 dpyinfo->x_id_name
9990 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
9991 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
9992 + 2);
9993 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
9994 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
9996 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
9997 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
9999 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10000 #ifdef USE_GTK
10001 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10002 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10003 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10005 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10006 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10008 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10009 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10010 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10011 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10012 #else
10013 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10014 #endif
10015 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10016 all versions. */
10017 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10019 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10020 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10021 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10022 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10023 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10024 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10025 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10026 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10027 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10028 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10029 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10030 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10031 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10032 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10033 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10034 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10035 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10036 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10037 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10038 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10039 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10040 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10041 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10042 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10043 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10044 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10045 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10046 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10048 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10049 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10050 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10052 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10054 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10055 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10056 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10057 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10058 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10059 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10062 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10063 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10065 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10067 Lisp_Object value;
10068 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10069 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10070 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10071 Qnil, Qnil);
10072 if (STRINGP (value)
10073 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10074 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10075 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10078 else
10079 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10080 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10082 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10084 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10085 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10086 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10087 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10088 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10089 for example). */
10090 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10091 double d;
10092 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10093 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10095 #endif
10097 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10099 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10100 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10101 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10102 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10103 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10104 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10105 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10106 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10107 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10110 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10111 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10112 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10113 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10114 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10115 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10116 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10117 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10118 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10119 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10120 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10121 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10122 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10123 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10124 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10125 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10126 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10127 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10128 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10129 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10130 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10131 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10132 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10133 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10134 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10135 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10136 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10137 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10138 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10139 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10140 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10141 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10142 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10143 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10144 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10145 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10146 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10147 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10148 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10149 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10150 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10151 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10152 /* For properties of font. */
10153 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10154 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10155 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10156 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10157 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10158 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10159 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10160 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10161 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10162 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10164 /* Ghostscript support. */
10165 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10166 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10168 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10169 False);
10171 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_XEMBED",
10172 False);
10174 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state
10175 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE", False);
10176 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen_atom
10177 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", False);
10178 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
10179 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ", False);
10180 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
10181 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT", False);
10182 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
10183 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", False);
10184 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type
10185 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", False);
10186 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip
10187 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP", False);
10188 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name
10189 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", False);
10190 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name
10191 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_NAME", False);
10193 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10194 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10195 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10196 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10198 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10199 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10200 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10202 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10203 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10206 dpyinfo->gray
10207 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10208 gray_bitmap_bits,
10209 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10210 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10213 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10214 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10215 #endif
10217 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10219 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10220 if (connection != 0)
10221 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10223 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10224 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10225 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10227 #ifdef SIGIO
10228 if (interrupt_input)
10229 init_sigio (connection);
10230 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10232 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10234 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10235 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10236 Font font;
10238 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10239 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10240 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10241 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10242 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10243 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10244 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10245 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10246 abort ();
10247 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10248 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10249 x_uncatch_errors ();
10251 #endif
10253 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10254 for debugging X code. */
10256 Lisp_Object value;
10257 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10258 build_string ("synchronous"),
10259 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10260 Qnil, Qnil);
10261 if (STRINGP (value)
10262 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10263 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10264 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10268 Lisp_Object value;
10269 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10270 build_string ("useXIM"),
10271 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10272 Qnil, Qnil);
10273 #ifdef USE_XIM
10274 if (STRINGP (value)
10275 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "false")
10276 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "off")))
10277 use_xim = 0;
10278 #else
10279 if (STRINGP (value)
10280 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10281 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10282 use_xim = 1;
10283 #endif
10286 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10287 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10288 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10289 tty. */
10290 if (terminal->id == 1)
10291 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10292 #endif
10294 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10296 return dpyinfo;
10299 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10300 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10302 void
10303 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10305 struct terminal *t;
10307 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10308 X display. */
10309 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10310 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10312 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10313 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10314 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10315 x_session_close ();
10316 #endif
10317 delete_terminal (t);
10318 break;
10321 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10323 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10324 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10325 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10326 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10327 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10328 else
10330 Lisp_Object tail;
10332 tail = x_display_name_list;
10333 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10335 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10337 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10338 break;
10340 tail = XCDR (tail);
10344 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10345 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10347 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10348 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10349 else
10351 struct x_display_info *tail;
10353 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10354 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10355 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10358 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10359 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10360 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10361 xfree (dpyinfo);
10364 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10366 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10367 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10368 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10369 that slows us down. */
10371 static void
10372 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10374 BLOCK_INPUT;
10375 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10376 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10378 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10379 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10380 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10381 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10383 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10386 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10387 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10388 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10389 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10390 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10391 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10392 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10394 void
10395 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10397 BLOCK_INPUT;
10398 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10400 EMACS_TIME interval;
10402 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10403 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10404 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10406 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10409 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10412 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10414 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10416 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10418 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10419 x_produce_glyphs,
10420 x_write_glyphs,
10421 x_insert_glyphs,
10422 x_clear_end_of_line,
10423 x_scroll_run,
10424 x_after_update_window_line,
10425 x_update_window_begin,
10426 x_update_window_end,
10427 x_cursor_to,
10428 x_flush,
10429 #ifdef XFlush
10430 x_flush,
10431 #else
10432 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10433 #endif
10434 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10435 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10436 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10437 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10438 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10439 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10440 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10441 x_draw_glyph_string,
10442 x_define_frame_cursor,
10443 x_clear_frame_area,
10444 x_draw_window_cursor,
10445 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10446 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10450 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10451 void
10452 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10456 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10457 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10458 if (!terminal->name)
10459 return;
10461 BLOCK_INPUT;
10462 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10463 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10464 X display. */
10465 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10466 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10467 #endif
10469 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10470 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10471 if (dpyinfo->display)
10473 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10474 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10476 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10477 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10478 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10479 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10481 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10482 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10483 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10484 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10485 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10486 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10487 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10488 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10489 leaks in other situations. */
10490 #if 0
10491 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10492 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10493 #else
10494 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10495 #endif
10496 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10497 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10498 closing all the displays. */
10499 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10500 #endif
10502 #ifdef USE_GTK
10503 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10504 #else
10505 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10506 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10507 #else
10508 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10509 #endif
10510 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10513 /* Mark as dead. */
10514 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10515 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10516 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10519 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10520 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10522 static struct terminal *
10523 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10525 struct terminal *terminal;
10527 terminal = create_terminal ();
10529 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10530 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10531 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10533 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10535 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10536 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10537 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10538 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10539 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10540 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10541 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10542 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10543 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10544 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10545 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10546 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10547 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10548 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10549 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10550 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10551 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10552 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10553 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10554 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10556 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10557 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10559 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10560 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10561 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10562 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10563 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10564 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10565 off the bottom. */
10567 return terminal;
10570 void
10571 x_initialize (void)
10573 baud_rate = 19200;
10575 x_noop_count = 0;
10576 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10577 any_help_event_p = 0;
10578 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10579 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10580 x_session_initialized = 0;
10581 #endif
10583 #ifdef USE_GTK
10584 current_count = -1;
10585 #endif
10587 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10588 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10590 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10591 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10593 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10595 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10596 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10597 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10598 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10599 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10600 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10601 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10603 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10604 #endif
10606 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10607 #ifndef USE_GTK
10608 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10609 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10610 #endif
10611 #endif
10613 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10614 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10615 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10617 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10618 original error handler. */
10619 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10620 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10622 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10624 xgselect_initialize ();
10628 void
10629 syms_of_xterm (void)
10631 x_error_message = NULL;
10633 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10634 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10636 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10637 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10639 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10640 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10642 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10643 Qlatin_1 = intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10645 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10646 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10648 #ifdef USE_GTK
10649 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10650 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10652 Qx_gtk_map_stock = intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10653 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock);
10654 #endif
10656 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10657 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10658 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10659 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10660 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10661 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10662 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10663 sizes. */);
10664 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10666 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10667 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
10668 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10669 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10670 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10671 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10672 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10674 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10675 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10676 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10677 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10678 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10679 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10680 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10681 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10682 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10684 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10685 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10686 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10687 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10688 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10689 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10690 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10691 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10692 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10693 #elif USE_GTK
10694 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10695 #else
10696 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10697 #endif
10698 #else
10699 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10700 #endif
10702 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10703 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10705 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10706 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10707 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10708 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10709 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10710 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10711 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10712 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10713 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10715 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10716 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10717 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10718 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10719 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10720 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10722 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10723 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10724 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10725 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10726 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10727 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10729 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10730 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10731 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10732 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10733 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10734 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10736 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10737 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10738 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10739 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10740 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10741 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10743 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10744 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10745 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10746 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10747 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10748 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10751 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10753 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10754 (do not change this comment) */